blob: de092dc28c68d08c34a723e299cf00cab95410d8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauba236302019-06-16 20:00:26 +02007 2019/06/16
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners adresses of the stats socket for every
493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners adresses of the master
496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100589 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200591 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200593 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - presetenv
597 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - uid
599 - ulimit-n
600 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200601 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100602 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-options
607 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - ssl-default-server-options
610 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100611 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100614 - 51degrees-data-file
615 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200616 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200617 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200618 - wurfl-data-file
619 - wurfl-information-list
620 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200621 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200624 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200626 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100627 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100628 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100629 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200630 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200631 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200632 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200633 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 - noepoll
635 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000636 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100638 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300639 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000640 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100641 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200642 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200643 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200644 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000645 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000646 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - tune.buffers.limit
648 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200649 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200650 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100651 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200652 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200653 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200654 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100655 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200656 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200657 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100658 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100659 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100660 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.session-timeout
662 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200663 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100664 - tune.maxaccept
665 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200667 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200668 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100669 - tune.rcvbuf.client
670 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100671 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200672 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100673 - tune.sndbuf.client
674 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100675 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100676 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200677 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200679 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200680 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100681 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200682 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100683 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
685 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
686 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100687 - tune.zlib.memlevel
688 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 * Debugging
691 - debug
692 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200693
694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696------------------------------------
697
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200698ca-base <dir>
699 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200700 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
701 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703chroot <jail dir>
704 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
705 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
706 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
707 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
708 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
712 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
713 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
714 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
715 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
716 set. These sets have the format
717
718 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
719
720 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
723 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100724 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
725 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100726 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100727 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
731 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
732 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
733 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100735 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
736 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
737 on the machine's word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
741 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
742 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
743 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
744 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
745 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100746
747 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
749
750 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
751 # first 4 CPUs
752
753 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
754 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
755 # word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
762
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
764 # and so on.
765 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100769 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
771 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
772 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
773
774 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
776 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
777
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
779 # and a thread range.
780 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
781 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
783
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200784crt-base <dir>
785 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
786 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
787 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789daemon
790 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
791 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100792 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
793 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200795deviceatlas-json-file <path>
796 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200798
799deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200801 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
802
803deviceatlas-separator <char>
804 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
805 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
806
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100807deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200808 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
809 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
810 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100811
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900812external-check
813 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
814 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
815 See "option external-check".
816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817gid <number>
818 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
819 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
820 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100821 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
822 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100825hard-stop-after <time>
826 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
827
828 Arguments :
829 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
830 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
831 SIGUSR1 signal.
832
833 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
834 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
835 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
836
837 Example:
838 global
839 hard-stop-after 30s
840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841group <group name>
842 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
843 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100844
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200845log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
846 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100847 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849 configured with "log global".
850
851 <address> can be one of:
852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100853 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100854 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
855 port).
856
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100857 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
858 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
859 port).
860
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100861 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100862 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
863 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100864 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100865
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
867 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
868 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
869 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
870 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
871 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
872 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
873 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
874 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
875 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
876 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
877 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
878 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
879 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100880 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
881 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100882
883 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
884 "fd@2", see above.
885
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200886 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
887 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100888
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200889 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
890 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
891 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
892 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
893 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
894 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
895 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
896 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
897 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
898 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
900 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200901
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200902 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
903 one of the following :
904
905 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
906 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
907
908 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
909 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
910
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100911 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
912 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
913 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
914 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
915 logger consumes.
916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100917 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
918 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
919 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
920 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
921
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200922 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
923 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
924 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
925 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
926 set with <sample_size> parameter.
927
928 <sample_size>
929 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
930 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
931 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
932 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
933 (see also <ranges> parameter).
934
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100935 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100937 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
938 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
939 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
942 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
943 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
944 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200947 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
948 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
949 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
950 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
951 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
952 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200954 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100956log-send-hostname [<string>]
957 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
958 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
959 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
960 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
961 the logs.
962
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000963log-tag <string>
964 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
965 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
966 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100967 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000968
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100969lua-load <file>
970 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
971 used multiple times.
972
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100973master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200974 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
975 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
976 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100977 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200978 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
979 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100980 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
981 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
982 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
983 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
984 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200985
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100986 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200987
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200988mworker-max-reloads <number>
989 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
990 survive to a reload. If the worker did not left after a reload, once its
991 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
992 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
993 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995nbproc <number>
996 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
997 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
998 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100999 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1000 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001001 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1002 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001004nbthread <number>
1005 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001006 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1007 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1008 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1009 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1010 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001011 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1012 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1013 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1014 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1015 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1016 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1017 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001020 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1022 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1023
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024presetenv <name> <value>
1025 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1026 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1027 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1028 and "unsetenv".
1029
1030resetenv [<name> ...]
1031 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1032 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1033 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1034 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1035 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1036 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1037 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1038 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1039
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001040stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001041 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1042 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1043 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1044 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1045 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1046 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001047 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001048 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1049 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1050 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1051 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001052
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053server-state-base <directory>
1054 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001055 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1056 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057
1058server-state-file <file>
1059 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1060 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1061 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1062 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1063 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1064 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1065 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1066 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001067 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1068 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070setenv <name> <value>
1071 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1072 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1073 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1074 and "unsetenv".
1075
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001076set-dumpable
1077 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1078 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1079 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1080 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1081 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1082 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1083 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1084 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1085 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1086 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1087 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1088 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1089 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1090 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1091 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1092 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1093 expected when dying.
1094
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001095ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1097 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001098 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001099 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001100 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1101 information and recommendations see e.g.
1102 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1103 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1104 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1105 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001106
1107ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1109 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1110 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1111 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1112 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001113 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1114 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1115 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001116 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001117
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001118ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1120 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1121 keyword to see available options.
1122
1123 Example:
1124 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001125 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001126
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001127ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1129 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001130 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001131 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001132 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1133 information and recommendations see e.g.
1134 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1135 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1136 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1137 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1138 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001139
1140ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1142 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1143 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1144 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1145 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001146 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1147 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1148 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1149 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001150
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001151ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1153 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1154 keyword to see available options.
1155
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001156ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1158 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1159 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001161 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001162 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1163 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1164 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1165 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001166 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1167 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1168 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1169
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001170ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1171 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1172 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1173 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001175stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1176 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1177 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1178 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001179 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001180 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001181
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001182 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1183 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1184 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001185
1186stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1187 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1188 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001189 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001190
1191stats maxconn <connections>
1192 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1193 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001195uid <number>
1196 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1197 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1198 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1199 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1200
1201ulimit-n <number>
1202 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1203 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1204 option.
1205
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001206unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1207 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1208
1209 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1210 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1211 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1212 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1213 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1214 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1215 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1216 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1217 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1218 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220unsetenv [<name> ...]
1221 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1222 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1223 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1224 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1225 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1226 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1227 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229user <user name>
1230 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1231 See also "uid" and "group".
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001233node <name>
1234 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1235
1236 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1237 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1238 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1239 traffic.
1240
1241description <text>
1242 Add a text that describes the instance.
1243
1244 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1245 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1246 "<" and ">" characters.
1247
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100124851degrees-data-file <file path>
1249 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001250 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001251
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001252 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1254
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000125551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001256 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1257 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1258 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1259
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001261 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1262
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200126351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001264 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1265 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1266
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001267 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1269
127051degrees-cache-size <number>
1271 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1272 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1273 By default, this cache is disabled.
1274
1275 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001276 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1277
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001278wurfl-data-file <file path>
1279 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1280 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1286 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1287 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1288 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1289
1290 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1291
1292 Valid WURFL properties are:
1293 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1294
1295 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1296 device.
1297
1298 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1299 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1300
1301 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1302 particular web request.
1303
1304 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1305 used Libwurfl API version.
1306
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001307 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1308 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1309
1310 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1311 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1312
1313 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1314
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001315 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1316 with USE_WURFL=1.
1317
1318wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1319 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1320 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
1325wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1326 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1327 thus before the chroot.
1328
1329 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1330 with USE_WURFL=1.
1331
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001332wurfl-cache-size <size>
1333 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1334 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001335 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001336 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001337
1338 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1339 with USE_WURFL=1.
1340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013413.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342-----------------------
1343
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001344busy-polling
1345 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1346 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1347 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1348 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1349 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1350 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1351 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1352 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1353 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1354 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1355 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1356 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1357 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1358 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1359 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1360 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1361 "poll" pollers.
1362
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001363max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1364 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1365 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1366 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1367 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1368 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1369 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1370 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1371 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001373maxconn <number>
1374 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1375 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1376 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001377 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1378 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1379 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1380 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001381 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1382 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1383 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1384 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1385 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1386 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001388maxconnrate <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1390 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1391 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1392 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1393 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1394 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1395 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1396 fairness.
1397
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001398maxcomprate <number>
1399 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001400 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001401 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1402 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1403 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001404 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001405 default value.
1406
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001407maxcompcpuusage <number>
1408 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1409 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1410 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1411 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1412 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1413 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1414 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1415 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1416
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001417maxpipes <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1419 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1420 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1421 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1422 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1423 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1424
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001425maxsessrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1427 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1428 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1429 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1430 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1431 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1432 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1433 fairness.
1434
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001435maxsslconn <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1437 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1438 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1439 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1440 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1441 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1442 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001443 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1444 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1445 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1446 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1447 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1448 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1449 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001450
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001451maxsslrate <number>
1452 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1453 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1454 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1455 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1456 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1457 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1458 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1459 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1460 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1461 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1462
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001463maxzlibmem <number>
1464 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1465 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1466 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001467 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1468 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1469 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471noepoll
1472 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1473 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001474 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
1476nokqueue
1477 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1478 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1479 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1480
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001481noevports
1482 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1483 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1484 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1485 also "nopoll".
1486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001487nopoll
1488 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1489 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001491 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1492 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001494nosplice
1495 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001497 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001498 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001499 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1500 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1501 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1502 "option splice-response".
1503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001504nogetaddrinfo
1505 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1506 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1507
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001508noreuseport
1509 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1510 command line argument "-dR".
1511
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001512profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1513 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1514 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1515 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1516 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1517 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1518 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1519 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1520 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1521 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1522
1523 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1524 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1525 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1526 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1527 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001528 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1529 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1530 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1531 CLI.
1532
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001533spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001534 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1535 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1536 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1537 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1538 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1539 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001542 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001543 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001544 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1545 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1546 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1547 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1548 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001549 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1550 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001551 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1552 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1553 openssl configuration file uses:
1554 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1555
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001556ssl-mode-async
1557 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001558 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001559 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1560 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1561 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1562 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1563 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001564
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001565tune.buffers.limit <number>
1566 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1567 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1568 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1569 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1570 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001571 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001572 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1573 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1574 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1575 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1576 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1577 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1578 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1579 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1580 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1581
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001582tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1583 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1584 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1585 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1586 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1587
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001588tune.bufsize <number>
1589 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1590 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1591 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1592 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1593 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1594 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1595 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001596 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1597 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1598 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001599 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001600 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1601 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1602 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001603
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001604tune.chksize <number>
1605 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1606 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1607 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1608 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1609 checks whenever possible.
1610
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001611tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1612 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1613 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1614 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1615 this value. The default value is 1.
1616
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001617tune.fail-alloc
1618 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1619 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1620 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1621 gracefully.
1622
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001623tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1624 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1625 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1626 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1627 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1628 change it.
1629
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001630tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1631 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001632 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1633 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001634 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1635 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1636 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1637 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1638 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1639
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001640tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1641 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1642 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1643 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1644 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1645 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1646 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1647 recommended not to change this value.
1648
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001649tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1650 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1651 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1652 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1653 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1654 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1655 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1656 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1657
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001658tune.http.cookielen <number>
1659 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1660 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1661 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1662 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1663 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1664 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1665 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1666 to change this value.
1667
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001668tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1670 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001671 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001673 configuration directives too.
1674 The default value is 1024.
1675
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001676tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1677 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1678 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1679 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1680 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1681 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1682 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001683 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1684 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1685 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001686
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001687tune.idletimer <timeout>
1688 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1689 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1690 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1691 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1692 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1693 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001694 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001695 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1696 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1697
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001698tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1699 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1700 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1701 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1702 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1703 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1704 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1705 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1706 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1707 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1708
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001709tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1710 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001711 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001712 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1713 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001715 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1716 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1717
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001718tune.lua.maxmem
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1720 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1721 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1722 memory.
1723
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001724tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1725 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001726 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1727 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001729
1730tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1731 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1732 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1733 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1734 check servers.
1735
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001736tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1737 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1738 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1739 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001742tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1744 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1745 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1746 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1747 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1748 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1749 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1750 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1751 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1752 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001753
1754tune.maxpollevents <number>
1755 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1756 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1757 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1758 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1759 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1760
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001761tune.maxrewrite <number>
1762 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1763 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1764 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1765 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1766 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1767 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1768 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1769 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1770 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1771 bufsize.
1772
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001773tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1774 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1775 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1776 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1777 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1778 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1779 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1780 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1781 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1782 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1783 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1784 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1785 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1786 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1787 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1788 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1789 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1790 setting this parameter to 0.
1791
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001792tune.pipesize <number>
1793 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1794 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1795 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1796 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1797 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1798 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1799
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001800tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1801 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1802 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1803 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1804 default is 20.
1805
1806tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1807 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1808 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1809 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1810 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1811 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1812 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1813 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1814
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001815tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1816tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1817 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1818 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1819 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1820 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001821 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001822 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1823 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1824
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001825tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001827 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1828 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1829 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1830 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1831
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001832tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1833 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1834 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1835 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1836
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001837tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1838tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1839 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1840 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1841 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1842 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001843 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001844 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1845 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1846 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1847 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1848 notifying haproxy again.
1849
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001850tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001851 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1852 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1853 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001854 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001855 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001857 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1858 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1859 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001860 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1861 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001862
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001863tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001864 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001865 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1866 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1867 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1868 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1869 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1870
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001871tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1872 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001873 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001874 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1875 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1876 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1877 being used for too long.
1878
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001879tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1881 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1882 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1883 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1884 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1885 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1886 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1887 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1888 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1889 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001890 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001891 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001892
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001893tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1894 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1895 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1896 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1897 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1898 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1899 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1900 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001901 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1902 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001903
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001904tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1905 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1906 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1907 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1908 1000 entries.
1909
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001910tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1911 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1912 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1913 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001915tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001916tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001917tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1918tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1919tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001920 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1921 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1922 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1923 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1924 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1925 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1926 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1927 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001928
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001929 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1930 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1931 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1932 all available space is consumed.
1933 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1934 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1935 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001936
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001937tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1938 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001939 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001940 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001941 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001942 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1943
1944tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1945 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1946 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1948 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019503.3. Debugging
1951--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001952
1953debug
1954 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1955 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1956 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1957 system startup.
1958
1959quiet
1960 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1961 line argument "-q".
1962
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019643.4. Userlists
1965--------------
1966It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1967http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1968it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1969
1970userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001971 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001972 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1973
1974group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001975 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001976 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1977 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1978
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001979user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1980 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1982 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001983 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1984 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1985 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1986 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001987
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001988 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1989 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1990 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1991 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1992 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1993 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1994 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1995 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1996 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001997
1998 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001999 userlist L1
2000 group G1 users tiger,scott
2001 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002002
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002003 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2004 user scott insecure-password elgato
2005 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002006
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002007 userlist L2
2008 group G1
2009 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002010
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002011 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2012 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2013 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002014
2015 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002017
20183.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002019----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002020It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2021several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2022instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2023values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2024automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2025In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2026using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2027tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2028reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2029Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2030that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2031each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032
2033peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002034 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002035 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2036
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002037bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2038 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2039 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2040
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002041disabled
2042 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2043 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2044 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2045
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002046default-bind [param*]
2047 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2048
2049default-server [param*]
2050 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2051
2052 Arguments:
2053 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2054 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2055 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2056 details.
2057
2058
2059 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2060
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002061enable
2062 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2063
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002064peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002065 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2066 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2067 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2068 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2069 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2070 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2071
2072 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2073 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2074
2075 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2076 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2077 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2078 across all peers.
2079
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002080 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2081 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002082
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002083 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2084 "server" keyword explanation below).
2085
2086server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002087 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002088 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2089 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2090 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2091 of this "peers" section).
2092 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2093
2094
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002095 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002096 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002097 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002098 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2099 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2100 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101
2102 backend mybackend
2103 mode tcp
2104 balance roundrobin
2105 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2106 stick on src
2107
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002108 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2109 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002110
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002111 Example:
2112 peers mypeers
2113 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2114 default-server ssl verify none
2115 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2116 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002117
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002118
2119table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2120 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2121
2122 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2123 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2124 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2125 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2126 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2127 "stick-table" keyword).
2128
2129 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2130 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2131 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2132 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2133 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2134 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2135 of the stick-table name as follows:
2136
2137 peers mypeers
2138 peer A ...
2139 peer B ...
2140 table t1 ...
2141
2142 frontend fe1
2143 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2144
2145 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2146 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2147
2148 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2149 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2150 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2151 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2152 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2153 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2154 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2155
2156 peers mypeers
2157 peer A ...
2158 peer B ...
2159 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2160
2161 backend t1
2162 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2163
2164 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2165 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2166 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2167
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021683.6. Mailers
2169------------
2170It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2171If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2172in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2173
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002174mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002175 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2176 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2177
2178mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2179 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2180
2181 Example:
2182 mailers mymailers
2183 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2184 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2185
2186 backend mybackend
2187 mode tcp
2188 balance roundrobin
2189
2190 email-alert mailers mymailers
2191 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2192 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2193
2194 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2195 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2196
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002197timeout mail <time>
2198 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2199 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2200 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2201 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2202
2203 Example:
2204 mailers mymailers
2205 timeout mail 20s
2206 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002207
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022083.7. Programs
2209-------------
2210In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2211master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2212managed the same way as the workers.
2213
2214During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2215sequence as a worker:
2216
2217 - the master is re-executed
2218 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2219 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2220 instance of the program
2221
2222During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2223
2224program <name>
2225 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2226 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2227 the management guide).
2228
2229command <command> [arguments*]
2230 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2231 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2232 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2233 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2234
2235option start-on-reload
2236no option start-on-reload
2237 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2238 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2239 program section.
2240
2241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022424. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002243----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002245Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002246 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002247 - frontend <name>
2248 - backend <name>
2249 - listen <name>
2250
2251A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2252its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2253section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
2256A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2257connections.
2258
2259A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2260to forward incoming connections.
2261
2262A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2263parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2266'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2267case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2268
2269Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2270logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2271proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2272However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2273name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2274
2275Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2276and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002277bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2279modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2280arbitrary criteria.
2281
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002282In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2283a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002284the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002285
2286 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2287 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2288 between responses and new requests.
2289
2290 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2291 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2292 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002293 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2294 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2295 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2296 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002297
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002298 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2299 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2300 client-facing connection remains open.
2301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002302 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2303 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002304
2305The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2306frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2307following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002308weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002309
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002310 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002311
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002312 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2313 ----+-----+-----+----
2314 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2315 ----+-----+-----+----
2316 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2317 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2318 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2319 ----+-----+-----+----
2320 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023244.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2325--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002327The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2328limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2329they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2330limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002331marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002332option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002333and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2334with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2335specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2340acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002341backlog X X X -
2342balance X - X X
2343bind - X X -
2344bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345capture cookie - X X -
2346capture request header - X X -
2347capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002348compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002349cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002350declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002351default-server X - X X
2352default_backend X X X -
2353description - X X X
2354disabled X X X X
2355dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002356email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002357email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002358email-alert mailers X X X X
2359email-alert myhostname X X X X
2360email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002361enabled X X X X
2362errorfile X X X X
2363errorloc X X X X
2364errorloc302 X X X X
2365-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2366errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002367force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002368filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002369fullconn X - X X
2370grace X X X X
2371hash-type X - X X
2372http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002373http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002374http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002375http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002376http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002377http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002378http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002379id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002380ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002381load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002382log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002383log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002384log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002385log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002386max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002387maxconn X X X -
2388mode X X X X
2389monitor fail - X X -
2390monitor-net X X X -
2391monitor-uri X X X -
2392option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2393option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2394option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2395option allbackups (*) X - X X
2396option checkcache (*) X - X X
2397option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2398option contstats (*) X X X -
2399option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2400option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002401-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2402option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002403option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002404option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002405option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002406option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002407option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002408option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002409option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002411option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412option httpchk X - X X
2413option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002414option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002416option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002417option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002418option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2420option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2421option logasap (*) X X X -
2422option mysql-check X - X X
2423option nolinger (*) X X X X
2424option originalto X X X X
2425option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002426option pgsql-check X - X X
2427option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002429option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002430option smtpchk X - X X
2431option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2432option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2433option splice-request (*) X X X X
2434option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002435option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002436option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2437option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2438-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002439option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002440option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2441option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2442option tcpka X X X X
2443option tcplog X X X X
2444option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002445external-check command X - X X
2446external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002447persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2448rate-limit sessions X X X -
2449redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002450reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2451reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2452reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2453reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2454reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2455reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2456reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2457reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2458reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2459reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2460reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2461reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002463reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002465retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002466rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2467rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2468rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2469rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2470rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2471rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2472rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002474server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002475server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002477stats admin - X X X
2478stats auth X X X X
2479stats enable X X X X
2480stats hide-version X X X X
2481stats http-request - X X X
2482stats realm X X X X
2483stats refresh X X X X
2484stats scope X X X X
2485stats show-desc X X X X
2486stats show-legends X X X X
2487stats show-node X X X X
2488stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2490stick match - - X X
2491stick on - - X X
2492stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002493stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002494stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002495tcp-check connect - - X X
2496tcp-check expect - - X X
2497tcp-check send - - X X
2498tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002499tcp-request connection - X X -
2500tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002501tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002502tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002503tcp-response content - - X X
2504tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002505timeout check X - X X
2506timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002507timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002509timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2510timeout http-request X X X X
2511timeout queue X - X X
2512timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002513timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002515timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002516transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002517unique-id-format X X X -
2518unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002519use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002520use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002521------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2522 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2526---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527
2528This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2529
2530
2531acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2532 Declare or complete an access list.
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | yes
2535 Example:
2536 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2537 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2538 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002540 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002541
2542
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002543backlog <conns>
2544 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2546 yes | yes | yes | no
2547 Arguments :
2548 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2549 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002550 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002551
2552 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2553 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2554 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2555 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2556 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2557 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2558 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2559 backlog parameter.
2560
2561 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2562 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2563 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2564
2565 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2566
2567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002569balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2572 yes | no | yes | yes
2573 Arguments :
2574 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2575 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2576 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2577 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2578
2579 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2580 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2581 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2582 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002583 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002584 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002585 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2586 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2587 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2588 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2589 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2590 it, so that you don't worry.
2591
2592 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2593 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2594 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2595 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2596 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2597 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2598 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2599 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002600
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002601 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2602 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2603 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2604 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2605 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2606 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2607 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2608 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2609
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002610 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002611 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002612 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2613 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002614 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002615 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2616 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2617 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2618 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2619 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002620 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2621 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2622 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2623 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2624 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2625 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2628 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2629 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2630 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2631 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2632 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2633 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2634 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002635 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002637 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2638 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2639 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002640
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002641 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2642 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2643 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2644 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2645 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2646 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2647 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2648 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2649 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002654 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002655 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2656 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2657 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2658 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2659 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2660 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2661 URIs start with a leading "/".
2662
2663 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2664 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2665 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2666 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002669 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2670
2671 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002672 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2673 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002674 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2675 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2676 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2677 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002678 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002679 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2680 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002681
2682 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2683 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2684 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2685 server will receive the request.
2686
2687 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2688 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2689 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2690 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2691 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002692 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2693 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2694 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002696 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2697 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2698 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2699 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2700 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002703 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2704 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2705 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2706
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002707 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2708 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2709 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2710
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002711 random
2712 random(<draws>)
2713 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002714 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2715 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2716 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2717 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002718 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2719 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2720 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2721 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2722 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2723 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2724 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2725 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2726 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2727 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2728 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2729 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2730 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2731 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2732 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2733 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2734 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2735 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2736 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2737 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002738
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002739 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002740 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002741 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2742 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2743 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2744 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2745 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2746 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002747 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002748 used instead.
2749
2750 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2751 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2752 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2753 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2754
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002755 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2756 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2757 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002759 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002762 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2763 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002764
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002765 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2766 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2767 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002768
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002769 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2770 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2771 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2772 NTLM relies on.
2773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774 Examples :
2775 balance roundrobin
2776 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002777 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002778 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2779 balance hdr(host)
2780 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002781
2782 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2783 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002785 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002786 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2787 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2788 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2789 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2790
2791 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2792 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2793 defaults to 16 kB.
2794
2795 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2796 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2797
2798 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2799 Round Robin.
2800
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002801 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002802 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2803 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2804 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2805
2806 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2807
2808 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002809 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002810 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2811 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2812 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002814 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
2816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002817bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2818bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2821 no | yes | yes | no
2822 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002823 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2824 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2825 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2826 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002827 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002828 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2829 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2830 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2831 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2832 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2833 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2834 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002835 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2836 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2837 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2838 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2839 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2840 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2841 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002842 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2843 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2844 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002845 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2846 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2847 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2848 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002849 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2850 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2851 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002852
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002853 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2854 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002855 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2856 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2857 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002858 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2859 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2860 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2861 the range.
2862
2863 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2864 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2865 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2866 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2867 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2868 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2869 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002870 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002871 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002873 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002874 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002875 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2876 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2877 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2878 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2879 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2880 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2881
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002882 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2883 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2884 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2885 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002887 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2888 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2889 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2890 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2891 in a frontend.
2892
2893 Example :
2894 listen http_proxy
2895 bind :80,:443
2896 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002897 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002899 listen http_https_proxy
2900 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002901 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002902
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002903 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2904 bind ipv6@:80
2905 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2906 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2907
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002908 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002909 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002910
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002911 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2912 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2913 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2914 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2915 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2916
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002917 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002918 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
2920
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002921bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002922 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2924 yes | yes | yes | yes
2925 Arguments :
2926 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2927 may be used to override a default value.
2928
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002929 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002930 option may be combined with other numbers.
2931
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002932 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002933 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2934 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2935 missing from all processes.
2936
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002937 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002938 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002939 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2940 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2941 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2942 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2943 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002944 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002945
2946 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2947 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2948 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2949 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2950 and 'even' instances.
2951
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002952 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2953 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2954 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2955 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002956
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002957 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2958 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2959
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002960 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2961 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2962 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2963
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002964 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2965 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2966
2967 Example :
2968 listen app_ip1
2969 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002970 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002971
2972 listen app_ip2
2973 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002974 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002975
2976 listen management
2977 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002978 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002979
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002980 listen management
2981 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2982 bind-process 1-4
2983
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002984 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002985
2986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002987capture cookie <name> len <length>
2988 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 no | yes | yes | no
2991 Arguments :
2992 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2993 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2994 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2995 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002996 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997
2998 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2999 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3000 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3001 right if it exceeds <length>.
3002
3003 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3004 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3005 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3006 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3007
3008 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3009 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3010 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3011
3012 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3013 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3014 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003015 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3016 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3017 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018
3019 Example:
3020 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3021
3022 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003023 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
3025
3026capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003027 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 no | yes | yes | no
3030 Arguments :
3031 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003032 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3034 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3035 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3036
3037 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3038 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3039 it exceeds <length>.
3040
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003041 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3043 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003044 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3045 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3046 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3047 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003048 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003049 environments to find where the request came from.
3050
3051 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3052 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3053 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3054 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003056 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3057 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3058 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3059 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3060 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061
3062 Example:
3063 capture request header Host len 15
3064 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003065 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003067 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 about logging.
3069
3070
3071capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003072 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 no | yes | yes | no
3075 Arguments :
3076 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003077 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3079 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3080 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3081
3082 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3083 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3084 it exceeds <length>.
3085
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003086 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3088 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3089 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003090 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3091 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3092 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3093 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003095 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3096 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3097 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3098 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3099 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
3101 Example:
3102 capture response header Content-length len 9
3103 capture response header Location len 15
3104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003105 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 about logging.
3107
3108
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003109compression algo <algorithm> ...
3110compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003111compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003112 Enable HTTP compression.
3113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3114 yes | yes | yes | yes
3115 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003116 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3117 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3118 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3119
3120 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003121 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3122 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3123 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003125 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003126 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003127
3128 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3129 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3130 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3131 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3132 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003133 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003134
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003135 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3136 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3137 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3138 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3139 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3140 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3141 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003142 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003143
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003144 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003145 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003146 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3147 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3148 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3149 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3150 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003151
3152 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3153 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3154 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3155 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3156 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003157 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3158 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3159 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3160 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3161 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003162 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3163 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003164
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003165 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003166 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3167 "Accept-Encoding" header
3168 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003169 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003170 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3171 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3172 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3173 "multipart"
3174 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3175 header
3176 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3177 and later
3178 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3179 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003180 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003181
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003182 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003183
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003184 Examples :
3185 compression algo gzip
3186 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003189cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003190 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3191 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003192 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3195 yes | no | yes | yes
3196 Arguments :
3197 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3198 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3199 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3200 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3201 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3202 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003203 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3205 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3206
3207 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3208 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3209 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3210 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3211 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3212 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003213 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3214 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003215 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003216 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3217 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003218
3219 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003220 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003221
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003222 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003223 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003224 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003225 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003226 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3227 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3228 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3229 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3230 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3231 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3232 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003233
3234 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3235 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3236 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3237 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3238 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3239 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3240 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3241 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3242 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003243 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003244 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3245 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3246 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003248 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3249 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3250 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003251 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3252 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3253 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3254 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003255 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3256 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3257 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003258
3259 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3260 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3261 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3262 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3263 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3264 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3265 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3266 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3267 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3268
3269 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3270 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3271 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3272 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3273 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3274 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3275 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3276 persistence cookie in the cache.
3277 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3278
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003279 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3280 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3281 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3282 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3283 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003284 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003285 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3286 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3287 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3288 they logout.
3289
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003290 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3291 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3292 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3293 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3294
3295 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3296 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3297 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3298 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3299 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3300 this attribute.
3301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003302 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003303 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003304 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3305 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3306 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3307 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3308 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3309 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003310
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003311 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3312 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3313 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3314 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3315 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3316 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3317 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3318 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003319 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003320 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3321 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3322 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3323 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3324 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3325 the site.
3326
3327 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3328 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3329 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3330 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3331 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3332 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3333 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3334 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3335 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3336 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3337 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3338 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3339 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003340 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003341 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3342 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3343
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003344 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3345 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3346 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3347 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3348 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3349 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3352 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3353 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3354 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003356 Examples :
3357 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3358 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3359 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003360 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003361
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003362 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003364
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003365declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3366 Declares a capture slot.
3367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 no | yes | yes | no
3369 Arguments:
3370 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3371
3372 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3373 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3374 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3375 for use in the response.
3376
3377 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003378 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003379 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3380
3381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003382default-server [param*]
3383 Change default options for a server in a backend
3384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3385 yes | no | yes | yes
3386 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003387 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3388 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3389 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3390 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003391
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003392 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003393 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3394
3395 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398default_backend <backend>
3399 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3401 yes | yes | yes | no
3402 Arguments :
3403 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3404
3405 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3406 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3407 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3408 will catch all undetermined requests.
3409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410 Example :
3411
3412 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3413 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3414 default_backend dynamic
3415
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003416 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003419description <string>
3420 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 no | yes | yes | yes
3423 Arguments : string
3424
3425 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3426 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3427 it describes.
3428 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3429
3430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431disabled
3432 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3434 yes | yes | yes | yes
3435 Arguments : none
3436
3437 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3438 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3439 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3440 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3441 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3442 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3443 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3444
3445 See also : "enabled"
3446
3447
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003448dispatch <address>:<port>
3449 Set a default server address
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003452 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003453
3454 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3455 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3456 during start-up.
3457
3458 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3459 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3460 possible with normal servers.
3461
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003462 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003463 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3464 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3465 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3466 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3467
3468 See also : "server"
3469
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003470
3471dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3472 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | no | yes | yes
3475 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3476
3477 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003478 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003479 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3480 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003482 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484enabled
3485 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | yes | yes | yes
3488 Arguments : none
3489
3490 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3491 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3492
3493 See also : "disabled"
3494
3495
3496errorfile <code> <file>
3497 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 yes | yes | yes | yes
3500 Arguments :
3501 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003502 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3503 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003504
3505 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003506 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003508 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3509 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003510
3511 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3512 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3513 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3514
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003515 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3518 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3519 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3520 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3521
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003522 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3523 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003525 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3526 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3527 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3530 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3531 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003532 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3534
3535 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3536
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003537 Example :
3538 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003539 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003540 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3541 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003543
3544errorloc <code> <url>
3545errorloc302 <code> <url>
3546 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | yes | yes | yes
3549 Arguments :
3550 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003551 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3552 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
3554 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3555 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3556 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3557 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559
3560 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3561 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3562 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3563
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003564 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3567 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3568 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3569 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003570 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3572 request.
3573
3574 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3575
3576
3577errorloc303 <code> <url>
3578 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | yes | yes | yes
3581 Arguments :
3582 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003583 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3584 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
3586 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3587 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3588 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3589 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003590 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003591
3592 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3593 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3594 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3595
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003596 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3597
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3599 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3600 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3601 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003602 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603
3604 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3605
3606
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003607email-alert from <emailaddr>
3608 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003609 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3611 yes | yes | yes | yes
3612
3613 Arguments :
3614
3615 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3616
3617 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3618 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003620 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003621 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3622 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003623
3624
3625email-alert level <level>
3626 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3627 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | yes | yes | yes
3630
3631 Arguments :
3632
3633 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3634 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3635 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3636
3637 By default level is alert
3638
3639 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3640 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3641 for the proxy.
3642
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003643 Alerts are sent when :
3644
3645 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3646 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3647 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3648 is notice or lower
3649 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3650 and a health check status update occurs
3651
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003652 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3653 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003654 section 3.6 about mailers.
3655
3656
3657email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3658 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | yes | yes | yes
3661
3662 Arguments :
3663
3664 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3665
3666 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3667 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3668
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003669 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3670 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003671
3672
3673email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3674 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3675 mailers.
3676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 yes | yes | yes | yes
3678
3679 Arguments :
3680
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003681 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003682
3683 By default the systems hostname is used.
3684
3685 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3686 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3687 for the proxy.
3688
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003689 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3690 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003691
3692
3693email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003694 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003695 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3697 yes | yes | yes | yes
3698
3699 Arguments :
3700
3701 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3702
3703 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3704 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3705
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003706 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003707 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3708
3709
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003710force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3711 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3712 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003713 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003714
3715 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3716 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3717 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3718 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3719 marked down for maintenance operations.
3720
3721 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3722 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3723 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3724 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3725 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3726 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3727 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3728 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3729 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3730
3731 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3732 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3733 is used.
3734
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003735 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003736 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003737
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003738
3739filter <name> [param*]
3740 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 no | yes | yes | yes
3743 Arguments :
3744 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3745 referenced in section 9.
3746
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003747 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003748 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003749 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3750 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003751
3752 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3753 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3754
3755 Example:
3756 listen
3757 bind *:80
3758
3759 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3760 filter compression
3761 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3762
3763 compression algo gzip
3764 compression offload
3765
3766 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3767
3768 See also : section 9.
3769
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003771fullconn <conns>
3772 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | no | yes | yes
3775 Arguments :
3776 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3777 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3778
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003779 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003780 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003781 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3783 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3784 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3785 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3786 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003787 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003788
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003789 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3790 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003791 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3792 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3793 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795 Example :
3796 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3797 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3798 # connections.
3799 backend dynamic
3800 fullconn 10000
3801 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3802 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3803
3804 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3805
3806
3807grace <time>
3808 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003811 Arguments :
3812 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3813 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3814 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3815
3816 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3817 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003818 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003819 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3820
3821 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3822 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3823 simplify it.
3824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003826hash-balance-factor <factor>
3827 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | no | yes
3830 Arguments :
3831 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3832 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003833 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003834
3835 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3836 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3837 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3838 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3839 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3840 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3841 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3842
3843 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3844 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3845 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3846 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3847 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3848
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003849 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3850 consistent hashing mechanism.
3851
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003852 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3853
3854
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003855hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003856 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | no | yes | yes
3859 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003860 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3861 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003862
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003863 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3864 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3865 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3866 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3867 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3868 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3869 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3870 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3871 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3872 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003873
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003874 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3875 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3876 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3877 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3878 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3879 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3880 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3881 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3882 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3883 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3884 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3885 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3886 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003887 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3888 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003889
3890 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3891
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003892 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003893 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3894 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3895 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003896 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3897 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3898 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003899
3900 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3901 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003902 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3903 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3904 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3905 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3906
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003907 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3908 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3909 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3910 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3911 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3912 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3913 parameter.
3914
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003915 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3916 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3917 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3918 used on strings.
3919
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003920 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3921
3922 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3923 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3924 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3925 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3926 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3927 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3928 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3929 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3930 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3931 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3932 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3933 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003934
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003935 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3936 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3937 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003938
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003939 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003940
3941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942http-check disable-on-404
3943 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003945 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3949 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3950 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3951 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3952 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3953 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3954 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3955 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003956 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3957 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3958 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3959
3960 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3961
3962
3963http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003964 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003966 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003967 Arguments :
3968 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3969 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003970 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003971 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3972 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3973 details on the supported keywords.
3974
3975 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3976 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3977 with the usual backslash ('\').
3978
3979 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3980 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3981 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3982 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3983 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3984
3985 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003986 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003987 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3988 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3989 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3990
3991 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003992 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003993 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3994 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3995 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3996 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3997
3998 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003999 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004000 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4001 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4002 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4003 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4004 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004005 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004006 trace).
4007
4008 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004009 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4011 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4012 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4013 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4014 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004015 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016
4017 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4018 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4019 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4020 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4021 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4022 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4023 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4024 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4025
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004026 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4027 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4028 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4029
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004030 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4031 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4032
4033 Examples :
4034 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004035 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004036
4037 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004038 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004039
4040 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004041 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004042
4043 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004044 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004046 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004047
4048
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004049http-check send-state
4050 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 yes | no | yes | yes
4053 Arguments : none
4054
4055 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4056 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4057 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4058 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4059 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4060
4061 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4062 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4063 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4064 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4065 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004066 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4067 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4068 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4069
4070 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4071 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4072 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4073
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004074 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4075 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4076 checked in multiple backends.
4077
4078 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4079 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4080
4081 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4082 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4083 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4084 one fails.
4085
4086 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4087 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4088 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4089
4090 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4091 server's queue.
4092
4093 Example of a header received by the application server :
4094 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4095 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4096
4097 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004099
4100http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004101 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4102
4103 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 no | yes | yes | yes
4105
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004106 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4107 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4108 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4109 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4110 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4113 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004115 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004117 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4118 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4119 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4120 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4123 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4124 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4125 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004126
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004127 Example:
4128 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4129 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4130 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132 http-request allow if nagios
4133 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4134 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4135 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004137 Example:
4138 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4139 acl add path /addacl
4140 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004142 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4145 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004147 Example:
4148 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4149 acl setmap path /setmap
4150 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4155 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4158 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4163 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4164 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4165 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4166 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4167 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4168 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4169 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004171http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4174 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4175 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4176 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4177 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4178 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4179 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4180 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4185 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4191 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4192 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4193 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4194 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 Example:
4197 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4198 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004199
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004200http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4205 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4208 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4209 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4210 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4211 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4212 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4213 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4214 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4215 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4218 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4219 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4220 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4221 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4222 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4227 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4228 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4229 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4230 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4231 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4240 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4241 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4242 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4243 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4244 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4249 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4250 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4251 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4252 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004253
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004254http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4255 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4256 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4257 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4258
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004259http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4260
4261 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4262 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4263 pointed by <resolvers>.
4264 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4265 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4266 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4267 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4268 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4269 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4270 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4271 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4272 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4273 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4274 to 0.0.0.0.
4275
4276 Example:
4277 resolvers mydns
4278 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4279 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4280 timeout retry 1s
4281 hold valid 10s
4282 hold nx 3s
4283 hold other 3s
4284 hold obsolete 0s
4285 accepted_payload_size 8192
4286
4287 frontend fe
4288 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4289 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4290 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4291
4292 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4293 # which mean DNS resolution error
4294 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4295
4296 default_backend be
4297
4298 backend b_503
4299 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4300 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4301 # 503 error page to end users
4302
4303 backend be
4304 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4305 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4306 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4307 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4308 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4309
4310 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4311 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4312
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004313http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4314
4315 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4316 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4317 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4318 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004319 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4320 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004321
4322 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4327 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4328 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4329 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4330 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4335 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4336 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4337 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004339http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4343 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4344 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4345 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4346 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4347 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4348 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4349 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 Example:
4352 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354 # applied to:
4355 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 # outputs:
4358 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004361
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004362http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4363 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4364
4365 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4366 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4367 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4368 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4369 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4370 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4371 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4372 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4373 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4374 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4375 match.
4376
4377 Example:
4378 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4379 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4380
4381 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4382 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4383
4384 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4385 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4386 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4387 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4388
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004389http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4390 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4393 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4394 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4395 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 Example:
4398 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 # applied to:
4401 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403 # outputs:
4404 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4407http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4410 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4411 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004415 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4416 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4417 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4422 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4423 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4424 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4425 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427 Arguments:
4428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4429 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 Example:
4432 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4433 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4436 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4441 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4442 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444 Arguments:
4445 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4446 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448 Example:
4449 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4450 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004452 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4453 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4454 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4459 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4460 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4461 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4462 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 Example:
4465 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4466 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4467 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4468 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4469 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4470 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4471 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4472 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4473 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004475http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004477 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4478 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4479 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4480 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4481 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004483http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4484 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004486 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4487 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4488 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4489 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4490 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4491 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4492 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4493 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4494 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004498 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4499 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4500 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4501 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4502 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4503 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4504 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4509 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4510 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004512http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4515 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4516 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4517 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4518 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4519 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4520 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4521 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4526 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4527 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4528 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4529 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4530 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 Example :
4533 # prepend the host name before the path
4534 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004538 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4539 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4540 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4541 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4542 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4547 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4548 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4549 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4550 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4551 values have higher priority.
4552 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4553 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4554 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4555 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4556 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4561 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4562 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4563 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4564 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4565 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4566 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004568 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004569
4570 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004571 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4572 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4575 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4576 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4577 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4578 privacy.
4579
4580 Arguments :
4581 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4582 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004583
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004584 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4586 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4587
4588 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4589 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4590
4591http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4592
4593 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4594 expression.
4595
4596 Arguments:
4597 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4598 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004599
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004600 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4602 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4603
4604 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4605 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4606 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4607
4608http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4609
4610 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4611 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4612 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4613 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4614 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4615 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4616 information from the request.
4617
4618 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4619
4620http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4621
4622 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4623 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4624 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4625 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4626 path and the query string.
4627 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4628
4629http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4630
4631 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4632 inline.
4633
4634 Arguments:
4635 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4636 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4637 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4638 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4639 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4640 (request and response)
4641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4642 processing
4643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4644 processing
4645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4646 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4647 and '_'.
4648
4649 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4650 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004651
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004652 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004653 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004655http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4659 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4660 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4661 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4662 agent name must be used.
4663
4664 Arguments:
4665 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4666
4667 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4668 configuration.
4669
4670http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4671
4672 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4673 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4674 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4675 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4676 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4677 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4678 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4679 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4680 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4681 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4682 action.
4683 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4684 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4685 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4686 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4687 you fully understand how it works.
4688
4689http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4690
4691 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4692 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4693 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4694 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4695 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4696 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4697 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4698 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4699 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4700 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4701 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4702 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4703 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4704
4705http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4706http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4707http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4708
4709 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4710 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4711 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4712 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4713 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4714 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4715 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4716 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4717 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4718 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4719 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4720 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4721
4722 Arguments :
4723 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4724 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4725 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4726 select which table entry to update the counters.
4727
4728 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4729 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4730 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4731 that table until the session ends.
4732
4733 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4734 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4735 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4736 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4737 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4738 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4739 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4740 useful information.
4741
4742 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4743 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4744 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4745 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4746 checks that make use of it.
4747
4748http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4749
4750 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004751
4752 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004753 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004755http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4758 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4759 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004762http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004763 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4764
4765 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 no | yes | yes | yes
4767
4768 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4769 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4770 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4771 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4772 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4773 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4776 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004779
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004780 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4781 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4782 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4783 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4786 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4787 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4788 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790 Example:
4791 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4796 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798 Example:
4799 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004801 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4804 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4807 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4812 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4813 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4814 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4815 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4816 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4817 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4818 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4823 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4824 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4825 example, or to pass some internal information.
4826 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4827 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4828 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4833 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004834
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004835http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4842 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4843 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4844 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4845 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4846 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4847 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4850 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4851 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4852 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4853 keyword.
4854 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4855 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004857http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004859 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4860 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4861 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4862 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4863 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4864 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004868 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004872 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4873 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4874 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4875 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4876 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4877 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004879http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4882 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4887 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4888 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4889 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4890 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4891 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4894 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4897 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4898 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4899 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4900 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4901 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4902 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4903 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905 Example:
4906 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908 # applied to:
4909 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 # outputs:
4912 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4920 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4921 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4922 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004924 Example:
4925 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927 # applied to:
4928 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930 # outputs:
4931 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4937 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4938 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4943 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4944 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004948 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4949 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4950 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4951 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4952 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 Arguments:
4955 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004957 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4958 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4963 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4964 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4967
4968 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4969 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4970 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4971 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4972 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4973
4974http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4975
4976 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4977 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4978 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4979 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4980 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4981 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4982 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4983 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4984 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4985
4986http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4987
4988 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4989 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4990 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4991 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4992 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4993 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4994 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4995
4996http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4999 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5000 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5001 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5002 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5003 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5004 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5005 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5006
5007http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5009
5010 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5011 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5012 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5013 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005014
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005015 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5017 http-response set-status 431
5018 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5019 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005023 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5024 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5025 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5026 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5027 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5028 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5029 based on some information from the request.
5030
5031 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5032
5033http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5034
5035 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5036 inline.
5037
5038 Arguments:
5039 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5040 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5041 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5042 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5043 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5044 (request and response)
5045 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5046 processing
5047 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5048 processing
5049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5050 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5051 and '_'.
5052
5053 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5054 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005055
5056 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5062 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5063 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5064 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5065 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5066 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5067 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5068 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5069 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5070 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5071 action.
5072 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5073 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5074 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5075 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5076 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5079http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5080http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005082 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5083 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5084 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5085 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5086 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5087 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5088
5089http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5090
5091 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5092 about <var-name>.
5093
5094 Example:
5095 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5096
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005097
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005098http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5099 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5100
5101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | no | yes | yes
5103
5104 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005105 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5106 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5107 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005108
5109 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5110
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005111 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5112 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5113 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5114 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5115 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5116 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5117 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5118 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5119 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5120 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005121
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005122 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5123 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5124 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5125 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5126 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5127 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5128 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5129 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005130
5131 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5132 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5133 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5134 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5135 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5136 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5137 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5138 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005139 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005140 downsides of rare connection failures.
5141
5142 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5143 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5144 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5145 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5146 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5147 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005148 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005149 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5150 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5151 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5152 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5153 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5154
5155 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005156 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5157 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5158 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005159
5160 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005161 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005162
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005163 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5164 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005165
5166 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5167 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5168 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5169
5170 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5171 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5172 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5173
5174 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5175
5176
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005177http-send-name-header [<header>]
5178 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5179
5180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5181 yes | no | yes | yes
5182
5183 Arguments :
5184
5185 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5186
5187 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005188 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005189 is added with the header string proved.
5190
5191 See also : "server"
5192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005193id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005194 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5196 no | yes | yes | yes
5197 Arguments : none
5198
5199 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5200 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5201 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005202
5203
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005204ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5205 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005207 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005208
5209 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5210 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5211 and running).
5212
5213 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5214 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5215 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005216 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005217 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5218
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005219 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5220 "unless" condition is met.
5221
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005222 Example:
5223 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5224 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5225 ignore-persist if url_static
5226
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005227 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5228
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005229load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5230 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | no | yes | yes
5233
5234 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5235 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5236 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005237 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005238 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5239 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5240 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5241 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5242
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005243 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005244 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005245 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005246
5247 Arguments:
5248 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5249 named "server-state-file".
5250
5251 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5252 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5253 name is used as a file name.
5254
5255 none don't load any stat for this backend
5256
5257 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005258 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5259 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5260 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005261 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005262 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005263
5264 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5265 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5266
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005267 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005268
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005269 global
5270 stats socket /tmp/socket
5271 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005272
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005273 defaults
5274 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005275
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005276 backend bk
5277 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5278 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005279
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005280
5281 Then one can run :
5282
5283 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5284
5285 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5286
5287 1
5288 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5289 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5290 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5291
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005292 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005293
5294 global
5295 stats socket /tmp/socket
5296 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5297
5298 defaults
5299 load-server-state-from-file local
5300
5301 backend bk
5302 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5303 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5304
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005305
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005306 Then one can run :
5307
5308 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5309
5310 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5311
5312 1
5313 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5314 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5315 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5316
5317 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5318 "show servers state"
5319
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005320
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005321log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005322log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5323 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005324no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005325 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005328
5329 Prefix :
5330 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5331 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5332 prefix does not allow arguments.
5333
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005334 Arguments :
5335 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5336 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5337 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5338 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5339 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5340 parameter.
5341
5342 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5343 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5344
5345 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5346 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5347 standard syslog port).
5348
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005349 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5350 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5351 standard syslog port).
5352
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005353 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5354 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5355 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005356 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005357
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005358 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5359 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5360 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5361 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5362 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5363 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5364 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5365 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5366 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5367 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5368 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5369 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5370 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5371 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5372 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5373 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005374 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5375 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005376
5377 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5378 and "fd@2", see above.
5379
5380 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5381 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005382
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005383 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5384 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5385 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5386 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5387 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5388 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5389 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5390 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5391 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5392 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005393 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005394
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005395 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5396 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5397 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5398 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5399 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5400
5401 <sample_size>
5402 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5403 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5404 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5405 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5406 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5407
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005408 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5409 one of the following :
5410
5411 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5412 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5413
5414 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5415 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5416
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005417 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5418 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5419 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5420 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5421 systemd logger consumes.
5422
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005423 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5424 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5425 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5426 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5427
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5429
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005430 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5431 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5432 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5433
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005434 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5435 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5436 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5437 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005438
5439 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5440 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5441 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005442 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5443 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5444 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5445 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5446 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005447
5448 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5449
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005450 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5451 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5452 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005453
5454 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5455 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5456 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5457 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5458
5459 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5460 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461
5462 Example :
5463 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005464 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5465 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5466 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005467 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5468 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005469 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005471
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005472log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005473 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5474 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5475 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005476
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005477 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5478 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5479 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5480 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5481 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005482
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005483 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5484 "option httplog" directives.
5485
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005486log-format-sd <string>
5487 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 yes | yes | yes | no
5490
5491 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5492 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5493 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5494 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5495 which covers the log format string in depth.
5496
5497 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5498 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5499
5500 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5501 log format to "rfc5424".
5502
5503 Example :
5504 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5505
5506
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005507log-tag <string>
5508 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 yes | yes | yes | yes
5511
5512 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5513 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5514 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5515 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5516 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5517 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5518 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5519 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5520 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005521
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005522max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5523 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5525 yes | no | yes | yes
5526
5527 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5528 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5529 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5530 servers.
5531
5532 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5533 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5534 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5535 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5536 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005537 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005538 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5539 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5540 picking a different server.
5541
5542 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5543 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5544 even if they have to be queued.
5545
5546 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5547 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5548
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005549max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5550 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5551 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5552 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554maxconn <conns>
5555 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 yes | yes | yes | no
5558 Arguments :
5559 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5560 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5561 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5562 closes.
5563
5564 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5565 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5566 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5567 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005568 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5569 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5570 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5571 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005572
5573 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5574 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5575 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5576
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005577 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5578 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005580 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5581
5582
5583mode { tcp|http|health }
5584 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | yes
5587 Arguments :
5588 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5589 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5590 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5591 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5592
5593 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5594 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5595 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5596 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5597 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5598
5599 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005600 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5601 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5602 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5603 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5604 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5605 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5606 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005607
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005608 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5609 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5610 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005611
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005612 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005613 defaults http_instances
5614 mode http
5615
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005616 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005618
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005619monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005620 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005623 Arguments :
5624 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5625 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005626 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005627 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5628 backend and its backup.
5629
5630 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5631 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5632 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5633 servers in a list of backends.
5634
5635 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5636 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5637 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5638 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5639 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5640 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5641 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005642 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5643 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005644
5645 Example:
5646 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005647 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005648 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5649 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5650 monitor-uri /site_alive
5651 monitor fail if site_dead
5652
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005653 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005654
5655
5656monitor-net <source>
5657 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 yes | yes | yes | no
5660 Arguments :
5661 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5662 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5663 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5664 followed by a mask.
5665
5666 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5667 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005668 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005669 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5670
5671 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5672 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5673 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5674 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005675 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5676 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5677 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005678
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005679 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5680 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5681 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5682 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5683 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5684 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005685
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005686 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5687 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005689 Example :
5690 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5691 frontend www
5692 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5693
5694 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5695
5696
5697monitor-uri <uri>
5698 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | no
5701 Arguments :
5702 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5703 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5704
5705 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5706 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5707 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5708 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5709 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5710 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5711 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5712 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5713
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005714 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5715 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5716 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5717 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5718 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5719 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5720 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5721 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005722
5723 Example :
5724 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5725 frontend www
5726 mode http
5727 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5728
5729 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005731
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005732option abortonclose
5733no option abortonclose
5734 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | no | yes | yes
5737 Arguments : none
5738
5739 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5740 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5741 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5742 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005743 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005744 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5745 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5746 encountered while delivering the response.
5747
5748 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5749 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5750 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5751 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5752 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5753 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005754 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005755 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005756 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005757 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5758 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5759 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5760
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005761 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5762 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005763 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5764 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5765 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5766 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5767 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5768 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005769 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005770
5771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5773
5774 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5775
5776
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005777option accept-invalid-http-request
5778no option accept-invalid-http-request
5779 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5781 yes | yes | yes | no
5782 Arguments : none
5783
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005784 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005785 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005786 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005787 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5788 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5789 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5790 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5791 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005792 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5793 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5794 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5795 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005797 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005798 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5799 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5800 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005801
5802 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5803 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5804 been confirmed.
5805
5806 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5807 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005808 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5809 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005810 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5811
5812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5814
5815 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5816 stats socket.
5817
5818
5819option accept-invalid-http-response
5820no option accept-invalid-http-response
5821 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5823 yes | no | yes | yes
5824 Arguments : none
5825
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005826 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005827 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005829 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5830 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5831 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5832 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5833 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005834 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5835 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5836 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005837
5838 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5839 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5840 been confirmed.
5841
5842 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5843 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5844 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5845 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5846
5847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5849
5850 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5851 stats socket.
5852
5853
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005854option allbackups
5855no option allbackups
5856 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | no | yes | yes
5859 Arguments : none
5860
5861 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5862 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5863 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5864 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5865 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5866 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5867 order between the backup servers anymore.
5868
5869 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5870 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5871
5872 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5873 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5874
5875
5876option checkcache
5877no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005878 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 yes | no | yes | yes
5881 Arguments : none
5882
5883 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5884 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005885 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005886 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5887 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005888 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005889
5890 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005891 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005892 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005893 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5894 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005895 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005896 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005897 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5898 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005899 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005900 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5901 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005902 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005903 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5904 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5905 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5906 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5907 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5908 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5909 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5910 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5911 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5912
5913 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005914 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005915 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005916 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005917 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5918
5919 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5920 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005921 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005922 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005923
5924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5926
5927
5928option clitcpka
5929no option clitcpka
5930 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | no
5933 Arguments : none
5934
5935 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5936 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005937 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005938 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5939
5940 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5941 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5942 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5943 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5944
5945 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5946 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5947 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5948 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5949 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5950
5951 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5952
5953 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5954 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5955 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
5960 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5961
5962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005963option contstats
5964 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | yes | yes | no
5967 Arguments : none
5968
5969 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5970 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5971 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5972 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005973 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5974 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5975 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5976 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5977 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005978
5979
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005980option dontlog-normal
5981no option dontlog-normal
5982 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5984 yes | yes | yes | no
5985 Arguments : none
5986
5987 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5988 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5989 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5990 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5991 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5992 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5993 logged.
5994
5995 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5996 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5997 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005999 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006000 logging.
6001
6002
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003option dontlognull
6004no option dontlognull
6005 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6007 yes | yes | yes | no
6008 Arguments : none
6009
6010 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6011 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6012 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6013 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6014 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6015 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006016 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6017 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6018 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006019
6020 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006021 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006022 would not be logged.
6023
6024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6026
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006027 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6028 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006030
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006031option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006032 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6034 yes | yes | yes | yes
6035 Arguments :
6036 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6037 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006038 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006039 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006040
6041 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6042 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6043 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6044 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6045 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6046 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6047 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006048 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6049 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6050 possible that the client has already brought one.
6051
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006052 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006053 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006054 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006055 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006056 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006057 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006058
6059 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6060 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6061 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6062 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6063 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6064 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6065 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6066
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006067 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6068 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6069 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6070 are under the control of the end-user.
6071
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006072 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006073 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6074 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006075 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6076 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6077 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006078
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006079 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006080 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6081 frontend www
6082 mode http
6083 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6084
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006085 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6086 backend www
6087 mode http
6088 option forwardfor header X-Client
6089
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006090 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006091 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006092
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006093
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006094option http-buffer-request
6095no option http-buffer-request
6096 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 yes | yes | yes | yes
6099 Arguments : none
6100
6101 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6102 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6103 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6104 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6105 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6106 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6107 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6108 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006109 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006110 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6111 default.
6112
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006113 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006114
6115
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006116option http-ignore-probes
6117no option http-ignore-probes
6118 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6120 yes | yes | yes | no
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6124 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6125 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6126 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6127 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6128 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6129 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6130 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6131 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006132 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6133 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006134 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6135
6136 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6137 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6138 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6139 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6140 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6141 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6142 are often the only way to detect them.
6143
6144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6146
6147 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6148
6149
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006150option http-keep-alive
6151no option http-keep-alive
6152 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6154 yes | yes | yes | yes
6155 Arguments : none
6156
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006157 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6158 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006159 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6160 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6161 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6162 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6163 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006164
6165 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6166 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006167 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6168 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6169 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6170 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6171 situations where this option may be useful :
6172
6173 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006174 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006175
6176 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6177 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6178
6179 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6180 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6181 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6182 request.
6183
6184 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6185 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006186 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6187 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6188 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006189
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006190 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6191 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6192 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6193 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6194 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6195 not set.
6196
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006197 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006198 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6199 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006200
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006201 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006202 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006203 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006204
6205
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006206option http-no-delay
6207no option http-no-delay
6208 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6210 yes | yes | yes | yes
6211 Arguments : none
6212
6213 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6214 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6215 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6216 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6217 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6218 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6219 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6220 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6221 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6222 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6223 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6224 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6225 affected.
6226
6227 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6228 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6229 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6230 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6231 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6232 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6233 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6234 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6235 latency environments.
6236
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006237 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6238
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006239
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006240option http-pretend-keepalive
6241no option http-pretend-keepalive
6242 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006244 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006245 Arguments : none
6246
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006247 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006248 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6249 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6250 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6251 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6252 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6253 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6254 consider the response complete.
6255
6256 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6257 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6258 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6259 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006260 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006261 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6262
6263 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6264 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6265 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6266 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6267 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6268 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6269 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6270
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006271 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6272 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6273 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6274 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6275 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6276 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006277
6278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6280
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006281 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006282 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006283
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006284
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006285option http-server-close
6286no option http-server-close
6287 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | yes | yes | yes
6290 Arguments : none
6291
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006292 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6293 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6294 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6295 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006296 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6297 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6298 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6299 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6300 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6301 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6302 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6303 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6304 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6305 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6306 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006307
6308 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6309 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6310 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6311 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006312 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6313 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006314
6315 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6316 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006317 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6318 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6319 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006320
6321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6323
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006324 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6325 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006326
6327
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006328option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6329no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6330 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006332 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006333 Arguments : none
6334
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006335 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6336 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6337 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6338
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006339 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6340 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6341 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6342 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006343 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006344
6345 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006346 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6348 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6349 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6350 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6351 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6352 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6353 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006354
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006355 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6356 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6357 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6358 backend.
6359
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6362
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006363 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6364 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006365
6366
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006367option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006368no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006369 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6371 yes | yes | yes | no
6372 Arguments : none
6373
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006374 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006375 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6376 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6377 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6378 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6379 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6380 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6381
6382 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6383 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006384 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6385 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6386 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006387
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006388 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6389 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6390 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6391 front of an existing proxy.
6392
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006393 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6394
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006395 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006396
6397
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006398option http-use-htx
6399no option http-use-htx
6400 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6402 yes | yes | yes | yes
6403 Arguments : none
6404
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006405 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006406 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006407 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6408 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6409 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6410 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6411 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006412
6413 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6414 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6415 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6416 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006417 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6418 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6419 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6420 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006421
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006422 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6423 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6424 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6425 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6426 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006427
6428 See also : "mode http"
6429
6430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006431option httpchk
6432option httpchk <uri>
6433option httpchk <method> <uri>
6434option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6435 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6437 yes | no | yes | yes
6438 Arguments :
6439 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6440 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6441 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6442 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6443 ones.
6444
6445 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6446 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6447 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6448
6449 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6450 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6451 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6452 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6453 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6454
6455 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6456 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6457 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6458 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6459 the lack of any response.
6460
6461 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6462
6463 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6464 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6465 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6466
6467 Examples :
6468 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6469 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6470 backend https_relay
6471 mode tcp
6472 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6473 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6474
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006475 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6476 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6477 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006478
6479
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006480option httpclose
6481no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006482 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | yes | yes | yes
6485 Arguments : none
6486
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006487 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6488 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6489 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6490 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006491 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006492
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006493 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6494 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6495 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6496 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6497 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006499 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6500 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6501 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006502
6503 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6504 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006505 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006506 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6507 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6508 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006509
6510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6512
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006513 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006514
6515
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006516option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006517 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006519 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006520 Arguments :
6521 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6522 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6523 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006524 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006525 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006526
6527 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6528 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6529 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6530 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6531 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6532 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6533 ports.
6534
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006535 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6536 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006537
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006538 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006540 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006541
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006542
6543option http_proxy
6544no option http_proxy
6545 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6547 yes | yes | yes | yes
6548 Arguments : none
6549
6550 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6551 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6552 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6553 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6554 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6555
6556 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6557 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006558 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6559 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006560
6561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6563
6564 Example :
6565 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6566 backend direct_forward
6567 option httpclose
6568 option http_proxy
6569
6570 See also : "option httpclose"
6571
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006572
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006573option independent-streams
6574no option independent-streams
6575 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6577 yes | yes | yes | yes
6578 Arguments : none
6579
6580 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6581 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6582 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6583 receive data or not.
6584
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006585 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006586 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6587 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6588 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6589 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6590 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6591 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6592 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6593 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6594 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6595 socket buffers.
6596
6597 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6598 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6599 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6600 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6601 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6602
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006603 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006604
6605
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006606option ldap-check
6607 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6609 yes | no | yes | yes
6610 Arguments : none
6611
6612 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6613 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6614 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6615 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6616
6617 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6618 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6619
6620 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6621 configure it.
6622
6623 Example :
6624 option ldap-check
6625
6626 See also : "option httpchk"
6627
6628
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006629option external-check
6630 Use external processes for server health checks
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6632 yes | no | yes | yes
6633
6634 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6635 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6636 command".
6637
6638 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6639
6640 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6641
6642
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006643option log-health-checks
6644no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006645 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6647 yes | no | yes | yes
6648 Arguments : none
6649
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006650 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6651 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6652 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006653
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006654 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6655 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6656 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6657 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6658 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6659
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006660 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006661 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006662
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006663 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6664 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6665 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006666
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006667
6668option log-separate-errors
6669no option log-separate-errors
6670 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | yes | yes | no
6673 Arguments : none
6674
6675 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6676 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6677 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6678 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6679 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6680 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6681 provides very important information.
6682
6683 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6684 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6685 error logs.
6686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006687 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006688 logging.
6689
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006690
6691option logasap
6692no option logasap
6693 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6695 yes | yes | yes | no
6696 Arguments : none
6697
6698 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6699 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6700 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6701 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6702 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6703 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6704 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006705 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006706 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6707 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006709 Examples :
6710 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6711 mode http
6712 option httplog
6713 option logasap
6714 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6715
6716 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6717 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6718 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6719 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006721 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006722 logging.
6723
6724
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006725option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006726 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6728 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006729 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006730 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6731 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006732 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006733
6734 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6735 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006736 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006737 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6738 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6739 in the MySQL table, like this :
6740
6741 USE mysql;
6742 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6743 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6744
6745 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006746 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006747 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6748 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6749 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6750 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6751 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6752 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6753 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6754
6755 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6756 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006757
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006758 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006759
6760 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6761 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6762 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6763 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006764 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6765 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006766
6767 See also: "option httpchk"
6768
6769
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006770option nolinger
6771no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006772 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006775 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006777 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006778 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6779 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6780 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6781 connections.
6782
6783 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6784 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6785 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6786 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6787 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6788 this too.
6789
6790 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6791 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6792 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6793
6794 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6795 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6796 for servers.
6797
6798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6800
6801
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006802option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6803 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6805 yes | yes | yes | yes
6806 Arguments :
6807 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6808 matching <network>
6809 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6810 header name.
6811
6812 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6813 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6814 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6815 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6816 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6817 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6818 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6819 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6820 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6821 possible that the client has already brought one.
6822
6823 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6824 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6825 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6826 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6827 header and requires different one.
6828
6829 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6830 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6831 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6832 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6833 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6834 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6835 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6836
6837 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6838 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6839 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6840 both are defined.
6841
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006842 Examples :
6843 # Original Destination address
6844 frontend www
6845 mode http
6846 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6847
6848 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6849 backend www
6850 mode http
6851 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6852
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006853 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006854
6855
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006856option persist
6857no option persist
6858 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006861 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006862
6863 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6864 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6865 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6866 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6867 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6868 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6869 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6870 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6871 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6872 redirected to another valid server.
6873
6874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006877 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006878
6879
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006880option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6881 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | no | yes | yes
6884 Arguments :
6885 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6886 PostgreSQL server.
6887
6888 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6889 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6890 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6891 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6892
6893 See also: "option httpchk"
6894
6895
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006896option prefer-last-server
6897no option prefer-last-server
6898 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6900 yes | no | yes | yes
6901 Arguments : none
6902
6903 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6904 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6905 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6906 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6907 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6908 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6909 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6910 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6911 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006912 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6913 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006914 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6915 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6916 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006917 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6918 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6919 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006920
6921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6923
6924 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6925
6926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006927option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006928option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006929no option redispatch
6930 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006933 Arguments :
6934 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6935 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6936 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006937 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006938 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006939 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006940 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6941 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6942 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006944
6945 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6946 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6947 be able to access the service anymore.
6948
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006949 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6950 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006951
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006952 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006953 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6954 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006956 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6957 "redisp" keywords.
6958
6959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6961
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006962 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006963
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006964
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006965option redis-check
6966 Use redis health checks for server testing
6967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6968 yes | no | yes | yes
6969 Arguments : none
6970
6971 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6972 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6973 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6974 find the "+PONG" response message.
6975
6976 Example :
6977 option redis-check
6978
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006979 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006980
6981
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006982option smtpchk
6983option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6984 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006987 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006988 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006989 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006990 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6991
6992 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6993 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6994 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6995
6996 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6997 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6998 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6999 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7000 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7001 dead server.
7002
7003 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7004 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007005 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007006 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7007
7008 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7009 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7010 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7011 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007012 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007013
7014 Example :
7015 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7016
7017 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007020option socket-stats
7021no option socket-stats
7022
7023 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7025 yes | yes | yes | no
7026
7027 Arguments : none
7028
7029
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007030option splice-auto
7031no option splice-auto
7032 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7034 yes | yes | yes | yes
7035 Arguments : none
7036
7037 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7038 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007039 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007040 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007041 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007042 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7043 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7044 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7045 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7046
7047 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7048 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7049 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7050 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7051 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7052 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7053 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7054 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7055 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7056 keyword.
7057
7058 Example :
7059 option splice-auto
7060
7061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7063
7064 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7065 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7066
7067
7068option splice-request
7069no option splice-request
7070 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7072 yes | yes | yes | yes
7073 Arguments : none
7074
7075 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007076 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007077 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7078 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7079 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7080 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7081
7082 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7083
7084 Example :
7085 option splice-request
7086
7087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7089
7090 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7091 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7092
7093
7094option splice-response
7095no option splice-response
7096 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 yes | yes | yes | yes
7099 Arguments : none
7100
7101 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007102 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007103 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7104 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7105 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7106 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7107
7108 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7109
7110 Example :
7111 option splice-response
7112
7113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7115
7116 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7117 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7118
7119
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007120option spop-check
7121 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 no | no | no | yes
7124 Arguments : none
7125
7126 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7127 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7128 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7129 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7130
7131 Example :
7132 option spop-check
7133
7134 See also : "option httpchk"
7135
7136
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007137option srvtcpka
7138no option srvtcpka
7139 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7141 yes | no | yes | yes
7142 Arguments : none
7143
7144 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7145 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007146 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007147 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7148
7149 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7150 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7151 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7152 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7153
7154 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7155 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7156 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7157 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7158 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7159
7160 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7161
7162 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7163 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7164 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7165
7166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7168
7169 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7170
7171
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007172option ssl-hello-chk
7173 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | no | yes | yes
7176 Arguments : none
7177
7178 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7179 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7180 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7181 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7182 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7183 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7184 hello message.
7185
7186 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7187 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7188 messages, which is appreciable.
7189
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007190 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7191 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7192 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007193
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007194 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7195
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007196
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007197option tcp-check
7198 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7200 yes | no | yes | yes
7201
7202 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7203 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7204
7205 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7206 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7207 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7208
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007209 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007210 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7211 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7212 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7213 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7214 only.
7215
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007216 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007217 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7218 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7219 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7220 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7221
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007222 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007223 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7224 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007225 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007226 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7227 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7228 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7229 the respective protocols.
7230 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007231 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007232
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007233 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7234 script.
7235
7236 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7237 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7238 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7239 The "comment" is of course optional.
7240
7241
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007242 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007243 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007244 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007245 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007246
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007247 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007248 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007249 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007250
7251 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7252 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007253 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007254 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007255 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007256 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007257 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007258 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007259 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7260 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007261 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007262 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7263 tcp-check expect string +OK
7264
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007265 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007266 (send many headers before analyzing)
7267 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007268 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007269 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7270 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7271 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7272 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007273 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007274
7275
7276 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7277
7278
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007279option tcp-smart-accept
7280no option tcp-smart-accept
7281 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | yes | yes | no
7284 Arguments : none
7285
7286 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7287 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7288 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7289 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7290 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7291 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7292
7293 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7294 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7295 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7296 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7297
7298 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7299 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7300 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007301 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007302
7303 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7304 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7305 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7306
7307 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7308 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7309 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7310
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007311 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7312
7313
7314option tcp-smart-connect
7315no option tcp-smart-connect
7316 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319 Arguments : none
7320
7321 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7322 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7323 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7324 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7325 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7326
7327 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7328 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7329 complex.
7330
7331 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7332 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7333 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7334
7335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7337
7338 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7339
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007341option tcpka
7342 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 yes | yes | yes | yes
7345 Arguments : none
7346
7347 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7348 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007349 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007350 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7351
7352 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7353 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7354 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7355 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7356
7357 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7358 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7359 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7360 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7361 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7362
7363 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7364
7365 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7366 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7367 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7368 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7369 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7370 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7371 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7372 backends.
7373
7374 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7375
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007376
7377option tcplog
7378 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007380 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007381 Arguments : none
7382
7383 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7384 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7385 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7386 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7387 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7388 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7389 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7390 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7391
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007392 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007394 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007395
7396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007397option transparent
7398no option transparent
7399 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007401 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007402 Arguments : none
7403
7404 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7405 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7406 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7407 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7408 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7409 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7410 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7411 appropriate server.
7412
7413 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7414 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7415
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007416 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007417 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007418
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007419
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007420external-check command <command>
7421 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | no | yes | yes
7424
7425 Arguments :
7426 <command> is the external command to run
7427
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007428 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7429
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007430 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007431
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007432 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7433 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7434 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7435 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7436 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7437 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007438
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007439 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7440
7441 Environment variables :
7442 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7443 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7444
7445 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7446
7447 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7448
7449 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7450 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7451 for a UNIX socket).
7452
7453 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7454
7455 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7456
7457 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7458
7459 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7460
7461 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7462
7463 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7464 socket).
7465
7466 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7467 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7468
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007469 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7470
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007471 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7472 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7473 failed.
7474
7475 Example :
7476 external-check command /bin/true
7477
7478 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7479
7480
7481external-check path <path>
7482 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 yes | no | yes | yes
7485
7486 Arguments :
7487 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7488
7489 The default path is "".
7490
7491 Example :
7492 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7493
7494 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7495 "external-check command"
7496
7497
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007498persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007499persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007500 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | no | yes | yes
7503 Arguments :
7504 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007505 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7506 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007507
7508 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7509 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007511 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7512 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7513 forwarded to this server.
7514
7515 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7516 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7517 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007518 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007519 a single "listen" section.
7520
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007521 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7522 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7523 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7524
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007525 Example :
7526 listen tse-farm
7527 bind :3389
7528 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7529 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7530 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7531 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7532 persist rdp-cookie
7533 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007534 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007535 balance rdp-cookie
7536 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7537 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7538
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007539 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7540 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007541
7542
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007543rate-limit sessions <rate>
7544 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 yes | yes | yes | no
7547 Arguments :
7548 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7549 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7550
7551 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7552 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7553 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7554 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7555 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7556 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7557
7558 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7559 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7560 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7561 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7562
7563 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7564 listen smtp
7565 mode tcp
7566 bind :25
7567 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007568 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007569
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007570 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7571 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7572 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007573
7574 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7575
7576
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007577redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7578redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7579redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007580 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 no | yes | yes | yes
7583
7584 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007585 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007586
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007587 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007588 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007589 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7590 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7591 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007592
7593 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7594 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7595 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7596 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7597 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007598 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7599 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7600 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7601 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007602
7603 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7604 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7605 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7606 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7607 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7608 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007609 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007610 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007611 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7612 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7613 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007614
7615 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007616 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7617 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7618 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007619 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007620 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7621 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7622 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7623 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007624
7625 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007626 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007627
7628 - "drop-query"
7629 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7630 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7631 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7632 with a location-type redirect.
7633
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007634 - "append-slash"
7635 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7636 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7637 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7638 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7639
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007640 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7641 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7642 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7643 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7644 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7645 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7646 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7647
7648 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7649 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7650 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7651 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7652 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7653 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7654 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007655
7656 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7657 acl clear dst_port 80
7658 acl secure dst_port 8080
7659 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007660 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007661 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007662 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7663
7664 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007665 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7666 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7667 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007668 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007669
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007670 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7671 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7672 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7673
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007674 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007675 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007676
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007677 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007678 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7679 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7680 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007682 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007683
7684
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007685reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 no | yes | yes | yes
7689 Arguments :
7690 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7691 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007692 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007693
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007697 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7698 the last header of an HTTP request.
7699
7700 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7701 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7702 responses.
7703
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007704 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7705 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7706 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7707
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007708 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7709 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007710
7711
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007712reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7713reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7716 no | yes | yes | yes
7717 Arguments :
7718 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7719 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7720 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7721 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7722 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7723 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7724 ignores case.
7725
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007726 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7727 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7728
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007729 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7730 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7731 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7732 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007733 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007734
7735 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7736 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7737
7738 Example :
7739 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7740 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7741 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7742
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007743 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7744 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007745
7746
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007747reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7748reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007749 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 no | yes | yes | yes
7752 Arguments :
7753 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7754 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7755 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7756 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7757 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7758 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7759
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007760 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7761 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7762
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007763 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7764 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7765 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7766 next servers.
7767
7768 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7769 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7770 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7771
7772 Example :
7773 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7774 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7775 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7776
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007777 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7778 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007779
7780
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007781reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7782reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007783 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 no | yes | yes | yes
7786 Arguments :
7787 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7788 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7789 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7790 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7791 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7792 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7793 case.
7794
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007795 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7796 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7797
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007798 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7799 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7800 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7801 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007802 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007803
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007804 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007805 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007806 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007807
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007808 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7809 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7810
7811 Example :
7812 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7813 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7814 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7815
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007816 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7817 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007818
7819
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007820reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7821reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007822 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 no | yes | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
7826 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7827 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7828 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7829 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7830 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7831 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7832 case.
7833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007834 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7835 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7836
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007837 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7838 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7839 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7840 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7841
7842 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7843 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7844
7845 Example :
7846 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7847 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7848 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7849 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7850
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007851 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7852 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007853
7854
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007855reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7856reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007857 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 no | yes | yes | yes
7860 Arguments :
7861 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7862 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7863 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7864 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7865 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7866 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7867
7868 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7869 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7870 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7871 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007872 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007874 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7875 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7876
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7878 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7879 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7880
7881 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7882 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7883 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7884 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7885 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7886
7887 Example :
7888 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007889 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007890 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7891 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7892
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007893 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7894 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007895
7896
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007897reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7898reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007899 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 no | yes | yes | yes
7902 Arguments :
7903 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7904 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7905 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7906 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7907 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7908 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7909 ignores case.
7910
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007911 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7912 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7913
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007914 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7915 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007916 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7917 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7918 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007919 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7920 not set.
7921
7922 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7923 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7924 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7925 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7926 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7927
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007928 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007929 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007930 # block all others.
7931 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7932 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7933
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007934 # block bad guys
7935 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7936 reqitarpit . if badguys
7937
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007938 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7939 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007940
7941
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007942retries <value>
7943 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7945 yes | no | yes | yes
7946 Arguments :
7947 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7948 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7949 default value is 3.
7950
7951 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7952 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7953 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7954
7955 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007956 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7957 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007958
7959 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7960 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7961
7962 See also : "option redispatch"
7963
7964
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007965retry-on [list of keywords]
7966 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7968 yes | no | yes | yes
7969 Arguments :
7970 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7971 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7972 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7973 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7974
7975 none never retry
7976
7977 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7978 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7979
7980 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7981 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7982 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7983 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7984 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7985 processing the request.
7986
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007987 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7988 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7989 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7990 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7991 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7992 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7993 overflow attack for example).
7994
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007995 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7996 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7997 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7998 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7999 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8000 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8001 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8002 amplify denial of service attacks.
8003
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008004 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8005 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8006 considered to be safe to retry.
8007
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008008 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8009 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8010 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8011 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8012
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008013 all-retryable-errors
8014 retry request for any error that are considered
8015 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8016 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8017 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8018
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008019 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8020 not cumulative.
8021
8022 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8023 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8024 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8025 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8026
8027 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8028 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8029 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8030 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8031 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8032 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8033 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8034 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8035 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8036 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8037 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8038 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8039
8040 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8041 should not use this directive.
8042
8043 The default is "conn-failure".
8044
8045 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8046
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008047rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008048 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 no | yes | yes | yes
8051 Arguments :
8052 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8053 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008054 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008055
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008056 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8057 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8058
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008059 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8060 the last header of an HTTP response.
8061
8062 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8063 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8064 responses.
8065
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008066 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8067 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008068
8069
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008070rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8071rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008072 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 no | yes | yes | yes
8075 Arguments :
8076 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8077 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8078 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8079 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8080 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8081 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8082 ignores case.
8083
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008084 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8085 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8086
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008087 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8088 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008089 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008090 client.
8091
8092 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8093 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8094 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8095
8096 Example :
8097 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008098 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008099
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008100 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8101 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008102
8103
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008104rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8105rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008106 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8108 no | yes | yes | yes
8109 Arguments :
8110 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8111 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8112 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8113 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8114 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8115 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8116 ignores case.
8117
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008118 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8119 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8120
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008121 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8122 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8123 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8124 case-sensitive.
8125
8126 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008127 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8128 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8129 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008130
8131 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8132 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8133
8134 Example :
8135 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8136 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8137
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008138 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8139 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008140
8141
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008142rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8143rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008144 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 no | yes | yes | yes
8147 Arguments :
8148 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8149 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8150 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8151 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8152 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8153 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8154 ignores case.
8155
8156 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8157 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8158 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8159 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008160 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008161
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008162 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8163 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8164
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008165 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8166 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8167 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8168
8169 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8170 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8171 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8172 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8173 are not case-sensitive.
8174
8175 Example :
8176 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8177 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8178
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008179 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8180 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008181
8182
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008183server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008184 Declare a server in a backend
8185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8186 no | no | yes | yes
8187 Arguments :
8188 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008189 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008190 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008191
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008192 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8193 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8194 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8195 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008196 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8197 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8198 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8199 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8200 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008201 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8202 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8203 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8204 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8205 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8206 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8207 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008208 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008209 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8210 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8211 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8212 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8213 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8214 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008215 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8216 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008217 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8218 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008219
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008220 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008221 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8222 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8223 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8224 adding this value to the client's port.
8225
8226 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8227 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008228 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229
8230 Examples :
8231 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8232 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008233 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008234 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8235 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8236 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008237
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008238 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8239 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8240 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8241 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8242 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8243
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008244 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8245 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008246
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008247server-state-file-name [<file>]
8248 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8249 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8250 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8251 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8252 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8253 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8254
8255 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8256 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8257
8258 global
8259 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8260
8261 backend bk
8262 load-server-state-from-file
8263
8264 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8265 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008266
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008267server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8268 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8269 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 no | no | yes | yes
8272
8273 Arguments:
8274 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8275
8276 <num | range>
8277 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8278 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8279 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8280 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8281
8282 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8283
8284 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8285
8286 <params*>
8287 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8288 keyword.
8289
8290 Examples:
8291 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8292 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8293 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8294
8295 # or
8296 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8297
8298 # would be equivalent to:
8299 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8300 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8301 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8302
8303
8304
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008305source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008306source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008307source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008308 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8310 yes | no | yes | yes
8311 Arguments :
8312 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8313 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008314
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008315 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008316 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8317 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8318 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8319 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8320 supported prefixes are :
8321 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8322 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8323 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008324 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008325 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8326 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327
8328 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8329 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008330 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8331 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8332 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
8334 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8335 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8336 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8337 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8338 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8339 <addr>.
8340
8341 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8342 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8343 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8344 port.
8345
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008346 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8347 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8348 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8349 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008350 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008351 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8352 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8353 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8354 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8355 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8356 HTTP header.
8357
8358 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8359 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008360 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008361 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8362 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8363 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8364 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8365 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8366 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8367 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8368
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008369 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8370 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8371 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8372 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8373 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8374 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8375
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008376 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8377 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8378 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8379 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8380
8381 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8382 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8383 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8384 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8385 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8386 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8387
8388 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8389 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8390 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8391 there are two methods :
8392
8393 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8394 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8395 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8396 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8397 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8398 of the client ranges may be used.
8399
8400 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8401 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8402 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8403 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8404 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8405 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8406 same session.
8407
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008408 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8409 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8410 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008411 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008412
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008413 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8414
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008415 Examples :
8416 backend private
8417 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8418 source 192.168.1.200
8419
8420 backend transparent_ssl1
8421 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8422 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8423
8424 backend transparent_ssl2
8425 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8426 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8427 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8428
8429 backend transparent_ssl3
8430 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8431 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8432 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8433
8434 backend transparent_smtp
8435 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8436 # with Tproxy version 4.
8437 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8438
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008439 backend transparent_http
8440 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8441 # proxy.
8442 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008444 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008445 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8446
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008447
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008448stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8449 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008451 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008452
8453 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8454 matched.
8455
8456 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8457 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8458
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008459 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8460 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008461 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008462
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008463 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8464 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8465 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8466 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008467
8468 Example :
8469 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8470 backend stats_localhost
8471 stats enable
8472 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8473
8474 Example :
8475 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8476 backend stats_auth
8477 stats enable
8478 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8479 stats admin if TRUE
8480
8481 Example :
8482 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8483 userlist stats-auth
8484 group admin users admin
8485 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8486 group readonly users haproxy
8487 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8488
8489 backend stats_auth
8490 stats enable
8491 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8492 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8493 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8494 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008496 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8497 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8498 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008499
8500
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8502 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505 Arguments :
8506 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8507
8508 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8509
8510 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8511 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8512 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8513 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8514 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8515 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8516
8517 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8518 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8519 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008520 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008521
8522 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8523 report using "stats scope".
8524
8525 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8526 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8527 unobvious parameters.
8528
8529 Example :
8530 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8531 backend public_www
8532 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8533 stats enable
8534 stats hide-version
8535 stats scope .
8536 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008537 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8539 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8540
8541 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8542 backend private_monitoring
8543 stats enable
8544 stats uri /admin?stats
8545 stats refresh 5s
8546
8547 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8548
8549
8550stats enable
8551 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008553 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554 Arguments : none
8555
8556 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8557 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8558 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8559 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8560 - stats auth : no authentication
8561 - stats scope : no restriction
8562
8563 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8564 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8565 unobvious parameters.
8566
8567 Example :
8568 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8569 backend public_www
8570 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8571 stats enable
8572 stats hide-version
8573 stats scope .
8574 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008575 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008576 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8577 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8578
8579 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8580 backend private_monitoring
8581 stats enable
8582 stats uri /admin?stats
8583 stats refresh 5s
8584
8585 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8586
8587
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008588stats hide-version
8589 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008591 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008592 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008593
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008594 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8595 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8596 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8597 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8598 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8599 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008600
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008601 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8602 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8603 unobvious parameters.
8604
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008605 Example :
8606 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8607 backend public_www
8608 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008609 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008610 stats hide-version
8611 stats scope .
8612 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008613 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008614 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8615 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008616
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008617 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8618 backend private_monitoring
8619 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008620 stats uri /admin?stats
8621 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008624
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008625
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008626stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8627 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8628 Access control for statistics
8629
8630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8631 no | no | yes | yes
8632
8633 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8634 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8635 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8636 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8637 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8638 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8639
8640 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8641 instance.
8642
8643 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8644 about ACL usage.
8645
8646
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008647stats realm <realm>
8648 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008650 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008651 Arguments :
8652 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8653 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8654 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8655
8656 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8657 using a backslash ('\').
8658
8659 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8660 only related to authentication.
8661
8662 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8663 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8664 unobvious parameters.
8665
8666 Example :
8667 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8668 backend public_www
8669 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8670 stats enable
8671 stats hide-version
8672 stats scope .
8673 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008674 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008675 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8676 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8677
8678 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8679 backend private_monitoring
8680 stats enable
8681 stats uri /admin?stats
8682 stats refresh 5s
8683
8684 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8685
8686
8687stats refresh <delay>
8688 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008690 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008691 Arguments :
8692 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8693 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8694 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8695 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8696 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8697 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8698
8699 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8700 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8701 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8702 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8703
8704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8706 unobvious parameters.
8707
8708 Example :
8709 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8710 backend public_www
8711 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8712 stats enable
8713 stats hide-version
8714 stats scope .
8715 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008716 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008717 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8718 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8719
8720 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8721 backend private_monitoring
8722 stats enable
8723 stats uri /admin?stats
8724 stats refresh 5s
8725
8726 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8727
8728
8729stats scope { <name> | "." }
8730 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008732 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008733 Arguments :
8734 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8735 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8736 section in which the statement appears.
8737
8738 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8739 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8740 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8741 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8742 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8743 exists.
8744
8745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8747 unobvious parameters.
8748
8749 Example :
8750 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8751 backend public_www
8752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8753 stats enable
8754 stats hide-version
8755 stats scope .
8756 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008758 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8759 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8760
8761 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8762 backend private_monitoring
8763 stats enable
8764 stats uri /admin?stats
8765 stats refresh 5s
8766
8767 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8768
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008769
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008770stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008771 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008773 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008775 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008776 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8777
8778 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8779 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8780
8781 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8782 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008783 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008784
8785 Example :
8786 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8787 backend private_monitoring
8788 stats enable
8789 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8790 stats uri /admin?stats
8791 stats refresh 5s
8792
8793 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8794 global section.
8795
8796
8797stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008798 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 yes | yes | yes | yes
8801 Arguments : none
8802
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008803 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008804 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8805 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8806 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8807 - IP (socket, server)
8808 - cookie (backend, server)
8809
8810 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8811 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008812 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008813
8814 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8815
8816
8817stats show-node [ <name> ]
8818 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008821 Arguments:
8822 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8823 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8824
8825 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8826 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008827 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008828
8829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8831 unobvious parameters.
8832
8833 Example:
8834 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8835 backend private_monitoring
8836 stats enable
8837 stats show-node Europe-1
8838 stats uri /admin?stats
8839 stats refresh 5s
8840
8841 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8842 section.
8843
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008844
8845stats uri <prefix>
8846 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008848 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008849 Arguments :
8850 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8851 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8852 query string.
8853
8854 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8855 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8856 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8857 possible to reach it in the application.
8858
8859 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008860 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008861 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8862 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8863 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8864 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8865
8866 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8867 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8868 an address or a port to statistics only.
8869
8870 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8871 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8872 unobvious parameters.
8873
8874 Example :
8875 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8876 backend public_www
8877 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8878 stats enable
8879 stats hide-version
8880 stats scope .
8881 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008882 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008883 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8884 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8885
8886 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8887 backend private_monitoring
8888 stats enable
8889 stats uri /admin?stats
8890 stats refresh 5s
8891
8892 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8893
8894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8896 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008898 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008899
8900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008901 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008902 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008903 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008904 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8905
8906 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8907 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8908 the "stick-table" statement.
8909
8910 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8911 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8912 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8913 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8914 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8915
8916 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8917 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8918 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8919 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8920 transformation rules.
8921
8922 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8923 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8924 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8925 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8926 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8927 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8928 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8929
8930 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8931 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8932 ACL based conditions.
8933
8934 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8935 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8936 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8937 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8938
8939 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8940 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8941 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8942 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8943
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008944 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8945 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008946 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008947
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008948 Example :
8949 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8950 # last 30 minutes
8951 backend pop
8952 mode tcp
8953 balance roundrobin
8954 stick store-request src
8955 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8956 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8957 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8958
8959 backend smtp
8960 mode tcp
8961 balance roundrobin
8962 stick match src table pop
8963 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8964 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8965
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008966 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008967 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008968
8969
8970stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8971 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 no | no | yes | yes
8974
8975 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8976 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8977 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8978 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008980 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8981 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008982 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008983
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984 Examples :
8985 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008986 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008987
8988 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8989 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8990 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8991
8992
8993 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8994 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8995 backend http
8996 mode http
8997 balance roundrobin
8998 stick on src table https
8999 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9000 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9001 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9002
9003 backend https
9004 mode tcp
9005 balance roundrobin
9006 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9007 stick on src
9008 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9009 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9010
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009011 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009012
9013
9014stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9015 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9017 no | no | yes | yes
9018
9019 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009020 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009021 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009022 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009023 server is selected.
9024
9025 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9026 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9027 the "stick-table" statement.
9028
9029 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9030 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9031 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9032 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9033 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9034 address.
9035
9036 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9037 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9038 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9039 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9040 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9041 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9042 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9043 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9044 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9045 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9046
9047 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9048 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9049 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9050 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9051 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9052 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9053 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9054
9055 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9056 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9057 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9058 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9059
9060 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9061 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9062 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9063 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9064 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9065 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009066 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9067 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9068 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9069 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9070 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9071 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009072
9073 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9074 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9075 the request.
9076
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009077 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9078 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009079 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009080
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009081 Example :
9082 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9083 # last 30 minutes
9084 backend pop
9085 mode tcp
9086 balance roundrobin
9087 stick store-request src
9088 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9089 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9090 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9091
9092 backend smtp
9093 mode tcp
9094 balance roundrobin
9095 stick match src table pop
9096 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9097 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9098
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009099 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009100 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009101
9102
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009103stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009104 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9105 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009106 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009108 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009109
9110 Arguments :
9111 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9112 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9113 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9114 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9115
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009116 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9117 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9118 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9119 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9120
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009121 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9122 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9123 instance.
9124
9125 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9126 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9127 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9128 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9129 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9130 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009131 to 32 characters.
9132
9133 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9134 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9135 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009136 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009137 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9138 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009139
9140 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009141 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9142 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009143 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9144 increase.
9145
9146 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009147 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9148 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9149 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009150
9151 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9152 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9153 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9154 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009155 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009156 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9157 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9158 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9159 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9160 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9161 parameter (see below).
9162
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009163 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9164 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9165 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9166 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9167 soft restart.
9168
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009169 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9170 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009171
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009172 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9173 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9174 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9175 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009176 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009177 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009178 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9179 if not expiration delay is specified.
9180
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009181 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9182 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9183 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9184 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009185 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9186 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9187 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9188 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9189 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9190 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9191 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9192 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9193 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9194 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9195 types and their arguments.
9196
9197 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9198 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9199 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9200 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9201
9202 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9203 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9204 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009205 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009206
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009207 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9208 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9209 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009210 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009211 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009212 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009213
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009214 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9215 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9216 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9217 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9218
9219 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9220 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9221 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9222 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9223 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9224 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9225
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009226 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9227 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9228 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9229 they were received.
9230
9231 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9232 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9233 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9234 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9235 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9236
9237 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9238 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9239 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9240 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9241 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9242
9243 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9244 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9245 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9246
9247 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9248 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9249 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9250 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9251 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9252
9253 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9254 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9255 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9256 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9257 the client side.
9258
9259 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9260 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9261 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9262 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9263 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9264 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9265 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9266
9267 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9268 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9269 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9270 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9271 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9272 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009273 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009274
9275 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9276 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9277 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9278 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9279 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9280 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9281
9282 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009283 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009284 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9285 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9286
9287 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9288 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9289 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9290 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9291 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9292 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9293 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9294 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9295 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9296 recommended for better fairness.
9297
9298 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009299 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009300 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9301 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9302
9303 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9304 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9305 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9306 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9307 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9308 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9309 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9310 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9311 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9312 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009313
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009314 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9315 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009316 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9317 reference it.
9318
9319 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9320 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009321 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9322 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9323 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009324
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009325 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9326 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9327 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9328 something that can be ignored.
9329
9330 Example:
9331 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9332 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9333 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9334 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9335
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009336 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009337 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009338
9339
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009340stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009341 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 no | no | yes | yes
9344
9345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009346 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009347 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009348 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009349 server is selected.
9350
9351 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9352 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9353 the "stick-table" statement.
9354
9355 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9356 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9357 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9358 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9359
9360 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9361 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9362 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9363 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9364 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9365 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009366 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009367 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9368 rules.
9369
9370 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9371 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9372 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9373 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9374 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9375 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9376 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9377
9378 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9379 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9380 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9381 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9382
9383 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9384 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9385 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9386 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9387 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9388 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009389 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9390 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9391 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9392 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9393 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9394 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9395 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9396 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9397 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009398
9399 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9400
9401 Example :
9402 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9403 backend https
9404 mode tcp
9405 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009406 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009407 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009408
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009409 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9410 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9411
9412 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9413 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9414 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9415
9416 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9417 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009418
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009419 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9420 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9421 # at offset 44.
9422
9423 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9424 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9425
9426 # Learn on response if server hello.
9427 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009428
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009429 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9430 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9431
9432 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9433 extraction.
9434
9435
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009436tcp-check connect [params*]
9437 Opens a new connection
9438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9439 no | no | yes | yes
9440
9441 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9442 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9443 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9444
9445 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9446 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9447 of the sequence.
9448
9449 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9450 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9451 do.
9452
9453 Parameters :
9454 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9455 use the TCP connection.
9456
9457 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9458 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9459 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9460
9461 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9462
9463 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9464
9465 Examples:
9466 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9467 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9468 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9469 option tcp-check
9470 tcp-check connect
9471 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9472 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9473 tcp-check send \r\n
9474 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9475 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9476 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9477 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9478 tcp-check send \r\n
9479 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9480 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9481
9482 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9483 option tcp-check
9484 tcp-check connect port 110
9485 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9486 tcp-check connect port 143
9487 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9488 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9489
9490 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9491
9492
9493tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009494 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9496 no | no | yes | yes
9497
9498 Arguments :
9499 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9500 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9501 binary.
9502 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9503 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9504 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9505
9506 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9507 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9508 with the usual backslash ('\').
9509 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009510 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009511 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9512 used upper or lower case.
9513
9514
9515 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9516
9517 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9518 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9519 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9520 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9521 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9522 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9523 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9524 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9525
9526 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9527 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9528 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9529 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9530 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9531 expression.
9532
9533 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9534 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9535 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9536 this exact hexadecimal string.
9537 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9538
9539 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9540 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9541 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9542 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9543 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9544 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9545 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9546 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9547 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9548 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9549 the null character.
9550
9551 Examples :
9552 # perform a POP check
9553 option tcp-check
9554 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9555
9556 # perform an IMAP check
9557 option tcp-check
9558 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9559
9560 # look for the redis master server
9561 option tcp-check
9562 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009563 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009564 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9565 tcp-check expect string role:master
9566 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9567 tcp-check expect string +OK
9568
9569
9570 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9571 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9572
9573
9574tcp-check send <data>
9575 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 no | no | yes | yes
9578
9579 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9580 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9581
9582 Examples :
9583 # look for the redis master server
9584 option tcp-check
9585 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9586 tcp-check expect string role:master
9587
9588 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9589 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9590
9591
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9593 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009594 tcp health check
9595 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 no | no | yes | yes
9597
9598 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9599 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009601 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9602 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9603 hexadecimal string.
9604 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9605
9606 Examples :
9607 # redis check in binary
9608 option tcp-check
9609 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9610 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9611
9612
9613 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9614 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9615
9616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9618 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009622 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9623 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009625 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009626
9627 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9628 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009629 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9630 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9631 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9632 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9633 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9634 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009636 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9637 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9638 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9639 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009640
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009641 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009642 - accept :
9643 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9644 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9645 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009647 - reject :
9648 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9649 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9650 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9651 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9652 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9653 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9654 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9655 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9656 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9657 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9658 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009659 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009660
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009661 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9662 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9663 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9664 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9665 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9666 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9667 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9668 hosts.
9669
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009670 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9671 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9672 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9673 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9674 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9675 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9676 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9677 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9678
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009679 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9680 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9681 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9682 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9683 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9684 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9685 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9686 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9687 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009688 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9689 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009690
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009691 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009692 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009693 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9694 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9695 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9696 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9697 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9698 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9699 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9700 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9701 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9702 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9703 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9704 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009705
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009706 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009707 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009708 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009709 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009710 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9711 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9712 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009714 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9715 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9716 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9717 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9720 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9721 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9722 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9723 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009724 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9725 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9726 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9727 layer7 information is extracted.
9728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009729 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9730 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9731 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9732 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9733 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009734
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009735 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9736 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9737 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9738 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9739
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009740 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9741 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9742 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9743 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9744
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009745 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9746 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9747 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9748 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9749 continues.
9750
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009751 - set-src <expr> :
9752 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9753 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9754 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009755 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009757 Arguments:
9758 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9759 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009760
9761 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009762 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9763
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009764 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9765 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009766
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009767 - set-src-port <expr> :
9768 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9769 expression.
9770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009771 Arguments:
9772 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9773 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009774
9775 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009776 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9777
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009778 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9779 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9780 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009781
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009782 - set-dst <expr> :
9783 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9784 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9785 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9786 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9787 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9788
9789 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9790 followed by some converters.
9791
9792 Example:
9793
9794 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9795 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9796
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009797 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9798 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9799
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009800 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9801 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9802 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9803 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9804
9805
9806 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9807 followed by some converters.
9808
9809 Example:
9810
9811 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9812
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009813 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9814 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9815 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9816
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009817 - "silent-drop" :
9818 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009819 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009820 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9821 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9822 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9823 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9824 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009825 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9826 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009827 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9828 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009830 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9831 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9832 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9833 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009835 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9836 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9837 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009838
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009839 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9840 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9841 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009842
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009843 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009844 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009845 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009846
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009847 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9848 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9849 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009850
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009851 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009852 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9853 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009854
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009855 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9856
9857 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9858
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009859 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9860
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009861 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009862
9863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009864tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9865 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009867 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009869 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9870 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009872 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009873
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009874 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9876 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9877 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9878 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009880 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9881 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9882 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9883 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009884 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9885 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9886 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9887 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9888 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9889 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009890 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009891 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009893 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9894 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9895 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9896 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009897
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009898 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009899 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009900 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009901 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9902 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009903 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009904 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009905 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009906 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009907 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009908 - set-dst <expr>
9909 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009910 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009911 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009912 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009913 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009914
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009915 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9916 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009917 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9918 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009919
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009920 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9921 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9922 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9923 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9924 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9925 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009927 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009928 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9929 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009931 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009932 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9933 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9934 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9935 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009936 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9937 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9938 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009939
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009940 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009941 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9942 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9943 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009944
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009945 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9946 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9947
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009948 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009949 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9950 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009951
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009952 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9953 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009954 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009955 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9956 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009957 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009958 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009959 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009960 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9961 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009962 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009963 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9964 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009965
9966 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9967 followed by some converters.
9968
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009969 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9970 <var-name>.
9971
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009972 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9973 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9974 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9975 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9976 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9977
9978 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9979 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9980 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9981 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9982 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9983 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9984 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9985 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9986 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9987 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9988 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9989
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009990 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9991 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9992 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9993 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9994 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9995
9996 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9997
9998 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9999
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010000 Example:
10001
10002 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010003 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010004
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010005 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010006 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10007 # and reject everything else.
10008 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10009 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010010 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010011 tcp-request content reject
10012
10013 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010014 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10015 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10016 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010017 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010018
10019 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10020 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10021 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010022 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010023 tcp-request content reject
10024
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010025 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010026 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010027 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010028 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010029 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10030 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010031
10032 Example:
10033 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10034 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010035 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010037 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010038 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010039
10040 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010041 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010042 # protecting all our sites
10043 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010044 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10045 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010046 ...
10047 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10048
10049 backend http_dynamic
10050 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010051 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010052 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010053 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010054 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010055 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010056 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010058 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010059
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010060 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10061 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010062
10063
10064tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10065 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010067 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010068 Arguments :
10069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10071 as explained at the top of this document.
10072
10073 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10074 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10075 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10076 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10077 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10078
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010079 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10080 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10081 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10082 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10083
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010084 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10085 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010086 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010087 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010088 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10089 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10090 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10091 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010092
10093 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10094 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10095 it pass through unaffected.
10096
10097 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10098 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10099 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010100 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010101 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10102 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010103 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10104 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10105 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010106
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010107 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010108 "timeout client".
10109
10110
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010111tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10112 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10114 no | no | yes | yes
10115 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010116 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10117 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010118
10119 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010121 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010122 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10123 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010124 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10125 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010126
10127 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10128
10129 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10130 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10131 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10132 inserted.
10133
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010134 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010135 - accept :
10136 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10137 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10138 the rules evaluation.
10139
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010140 - close :
10141 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10142 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10143 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10144 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10145 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10146 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010147 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010148 protocols.
10149
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010150 - reject :
10151 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10152 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010153 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010154
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010155 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10156 Sets a variable.
10157
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010158 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10159 Unsets a variable.
10160
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010161 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10162 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10163 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10164 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10165
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010166 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10167 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10168 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10169 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10170
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010171 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10172 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10173 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10174 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10175 continues.
10176
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010177 - "silent-drop" :
10178 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010179 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010180 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10181 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10182 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10183 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10184 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010185 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10186 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010187 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10188 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010189 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010190 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10191 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10192 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10193 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10194
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010195 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10196 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10197
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010198 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10199 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10200 for changing the default action to a reject.
10201
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010202 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10203 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10204 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10205 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010206 period.
10207
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010208 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10209 declared inline.
10210
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010211 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10212 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010213 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010214 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10215 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010216 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010217 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010218 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010219 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10220 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010222 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10223 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010224
10225 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10226 followed by some converters.
10227
10228 Example:
10229
10230 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10231
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010232 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10233 <var-name>.
10234
10235 Example:
10236
10237 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10238
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010239 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10240 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10241 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10242 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10243 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10244
10245 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10246
10247 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10248
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010249 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10250
10251 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10252
10253
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010254tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10255 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10257 no | yes | yes | no
10258 Arguments :
10259 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10260 below.
10261
10262 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10263
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010265 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10266 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10267 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10268 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10269 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10270 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10271 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010272 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010273 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10274 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10275 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10276 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10277 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10278 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10279 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10280 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10281 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10282 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10283 instead.
10284
10285 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10286 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10287 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10288 rules which may be inserted.
10289
10290 Several types of actions are supported :
10291 - accept : the request is accepted
10292 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10293 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10294 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010295 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010296 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10297 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010298 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010299 - silent-drop
10300
10301 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10302 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10303 sections for a complete description.
10304
10305 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10306 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10307 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10308
10309 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10310 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10311 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10312 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10313 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10314
10315 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10316 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10317
10318 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10319 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10320 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10321
10322 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10323 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10324 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10325
10326 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10327 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10328 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10329
10330 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10331 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10332 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10333
10334 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10335
10336 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10337
10338
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010339tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10340 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10342 no | no | yes | yes
10343 Arguments :
10344 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10345 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10346 as explained at the top of this document.
10347
10348 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10349
10350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010351timeout check <timeout>
10352 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10353 established.
10354
10355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10356 yes | no | yes | yes
10357 Arguments:
10358 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10359 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10360 as explained at the top of this document.
10361
10362 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10363 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010365 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010366 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10367 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10368 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010369
10370 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10371 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10372
10373 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10374 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010375 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010376
10377 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10378 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10379 forget about it.
10380
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010381 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10382 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010383
10384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010385timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010386 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10388 yes | yes | yes | no
10389 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010390 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010391 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10392 as explained at the top of this document.
10393
10394 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10395 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10396 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010397 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10398 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10399 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10400 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010401 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10402 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10403 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010404 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010405 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010406 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10407 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010408 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10409 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010410
10411 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10412 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10413 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10414 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10415 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10416 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10417
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010418 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010419
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010420 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010422
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010423timeout client-fin <timeout>
10424 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | yes | yes | no
10427 Arguments :
10428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10430 as explained at the top of this document.
10431
10432 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10433 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10434 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10435 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10436 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10437 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10438 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010439 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10440 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10441 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010442
10443 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10444 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10445 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10446
10447 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10448
10449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010450timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010451 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10453 yes | no | yes | yes
10454 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010455 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010456 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10457 as explained at the top of this document.
10458
10459 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010460 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010461 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010462 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010463 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10464 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010465
10466 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10467 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10468 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10469 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10470 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10471 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10472
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010473 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010475
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010476timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10477 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10479 yes | yes | yes | yes
10480 Arguments :
10481 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10482 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10483 as explained at the top of this document.
10484
10485 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10486 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10487 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10488 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10489 once the request has started to present itself.
10490
10491 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10492 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10493 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10494 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10495 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10496
10497 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10498 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10499 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10500 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10501
10502 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10503 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010504 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010505 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10506 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010507 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010508
10509 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10510 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10511 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10512 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10513
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010514 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10515 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010516 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10517
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010518 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10519
10520
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010521timeout http-request <timeout>
10522 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010524 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010525 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10528 as explained at the top of this document.
10529
10530 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10531 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10532 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10533 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10534 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10535 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10536 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010537 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10538 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10539 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10540 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010541 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010542 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10543 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010544
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010545 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10546 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10547 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10548 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10549 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010550 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010551
10552 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10553 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010554 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010555 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10556 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10557
10558 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010559 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10560 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10561 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010562
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010563 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010564 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010565
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010566
10567timeout queue <timeout>
10568 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 yes | no | yes | yes
10571 Arguments :
10572 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10573 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10574 as explained at the top of this document.
10575
10576 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10577 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10578 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10579 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10580 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10581
10582 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10583 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10584 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10585 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10586
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010587 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010588
10589
10590timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010591 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10593 yes | no | yes | yes
10594 Arguments :
10595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10597 as explained at the top of this document.
10598
10599 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10600 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10601 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10602 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10603 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10604 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10605 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10606
10607 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10608 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10609 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10610 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10611 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010612 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010613 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010614 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10615 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010616 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10617 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010618
10619 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10620 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10621 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10622 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10623 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10624 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10625
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010626 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010627
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010628
10629timeout server-fin <timeout>
10630 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10632 yes | no | yes | yes
10633 Arguments :
10634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10636 as explained at the top of this document.
10637
10638 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10639 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10640 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10641 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10642 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10643 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10644 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10645 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10646 situations, it should not be needed.
10647
10648 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10649 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10650 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10651
10652 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10653
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010654
10655timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010656 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10658 yes | yes | yes | yes
10659 Arguments :
10660 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10661 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10662 as explained at the top of this document.
10663
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010664 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10665 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10666 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10667 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010668
10669 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10670 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10671 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10672 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010673 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010674
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010675 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010676
10677
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010678timeout tunnel <timeout>
10679 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10681 yes | no | yes | yes
10682 Arguments :
10683 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10684 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10685 as explained at the top of this document.
10686
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010687 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010688 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10689 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10690 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010691 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10692 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010693 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10694 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10695 specified.
10696
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010697 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10698 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10699 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10700 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10701 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10702 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10703 state.
10704
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010705 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10706 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10707 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10708 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010710
10711 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10712 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10713 forget about it.
10714
10715 Example :
10716 defaults http
10717 option http-server-close
10718 timeout connect 5s
10719 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010720 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010721 timeout server 30s
10722 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10723
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010724 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010725
10726
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010727transparent (deprecated)
10728 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010730 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010731 Arguments : none
10732
10733 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10734 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10735 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10736 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10737 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10738 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10739 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10740 appropriate server.
10741
10742 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10743
10744 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10745 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10746
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010747 See also: "option transparent"
10748
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010749unique-id-format <string>
10750 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10752 yes | yes | yes | no
10753 Arguments :
10754 <string> is a log-format string.
10755
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010756 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10757 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10758 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10759 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010760
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010761 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10762 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10763 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10764 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10765 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10766 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10767 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10768 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010769
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010770 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10771 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010772
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010773 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010774
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010775 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010776
10777 will generate:
10778
10779 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10780
10781 See also: "unique-id-header"
10782
10783unique-id-header <name>
10784 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10786 yes | yes | yes | no
10787 Arguments :
10788 <name> is the name of the header.
10789
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010790 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10791 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010792
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010793 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010794
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010795 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010796 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10797
10798 will generate:
10799
10800 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10801
10802 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010803
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010804use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010805 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10807 no | yes | yes | no
10808 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010809 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10810 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010811
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010812 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10813 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010814
10815 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10816 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10817 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010818 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010819 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010820 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10821 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010822
10823 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10824 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10825 assign the backend.
10826
10827 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10828 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10829 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10830 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10831 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10832 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10833
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010834 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010835 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010836 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10837 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10838 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10839
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010840 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10841 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10842 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10843 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10844 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10845 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10846 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10847 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10848 cannot be forced from the request.
10849
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010850 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010851 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10852 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10853
10854 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10855 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010856
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010857
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010858use-server <server> if <condition>
10859use-server <server> unless <condition>
10860 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10862 no | no | yes | yes
10863 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010864 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010865
10866 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10867
10868 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10869 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10870 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10871
10872 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10873 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10874 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10875 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10876 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10877 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10878 matches will assign the server.
10879
10880 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10881 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10882 with the next rules until one matches.
10883
10884 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10885 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10886 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10887 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10888
10889 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10890 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10891 stripped.
10892
10893 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10894 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10895 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10896 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10897
10898 Example :
10899 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10900 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10901 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10902 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10903 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10904 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010905 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010906 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10907 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10908
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010909 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010910
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010911
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100109125. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010913--------------------------
10914
10915The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10916depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10917settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10918written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10919described in this section.
10920
10921
109225.1. Bind options
10923-----------------
10924
10925The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10926as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10927no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10928parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10929while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10930provided immediately after the setting name.
10931
10932The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10933
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010934accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10935 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10936 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10937 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10938 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10939 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10940 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10941 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10942 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10943 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010944 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10945 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10946 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010948accept-proxy
10949 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010950 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10951 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010952 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10953 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10954 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10955 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010957 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10958 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010959 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10960 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010961
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010962allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010963 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010964 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10965 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10966 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10967 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010968
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010969alpn <protocols>
10970 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10971 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10972 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10973 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10974 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010975 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10976 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10977 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10978 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10979 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10980 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10981 preference, like below :
10982
10983 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010984
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010985backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010986 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010987 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10988
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010989curves <curves>
10990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10991 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10992 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10993 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10994 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10995 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10996
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010997ecdhe <named curve>
10998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010999 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11000 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011001
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011002ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11004 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11005 client's certificate.
11006
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011007ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11009 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11010 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11011 error is ignored.
11012
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011013ca-sign-file <cafile>
11014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11015 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11016 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11017 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11018 'generate-certificates' for details.
11019
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011020ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11022 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11023 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11024 'generate-certificates' for details.
11025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011026ciphers <ciphers>
11027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11028 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011029 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011030 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011031 information and recommendations see e.g.
11032 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11033 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11034 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11035
11036ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11038 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11039 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11040 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011041 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11042 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011043
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011044crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11046 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11047 to verify client's certificate.
11048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011049crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11051 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11052 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11053 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11054 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11055 file.
11056
11057 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11058 are loaded.
11059
11060 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011061 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011062 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11063 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11064 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11065 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011066 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11067 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011068 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011069
11070 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11071 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11072 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11073 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011074 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11075 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011076
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011077 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011078
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011079 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011080 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011081 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11082 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011083 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11084 clients).
11085
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011086 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11087 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11088 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11089 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11090 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11091 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11092 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11093 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11094 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11095 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11096 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11097 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11098 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11099
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011100 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11101 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11102 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11103 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11104 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11105
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011106 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11107 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11108 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11109 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011110
11111 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11112 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11113 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11114 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11115 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11116 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11117 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11118 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11119 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11120
11121 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11122
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011123 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011124 a cert bundle.
11125
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011126 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011127 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11128 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11129 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11130 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11131 provide multi-cert support.
11132
11133 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11134
11135 Filename | CN | SAN
11136 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11137 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011138 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011139 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11140 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11141
11142 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11143 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11144 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11145 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011146 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11147 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11148 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011149
11150 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11151 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11152
11153 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11154 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11155 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11156
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011157crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011159 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011160 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011161 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011162
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011163crt-list <file>
11164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011165 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11166 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011167
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011168 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11169
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011170 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11171 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011172 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011173 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011174
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011175 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11176 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11177 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11178 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11179 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11180 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11181 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11182 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011183
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011184 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011185 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011186 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11187 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11188 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011189
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011190 crt-list file example:
11191 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011192 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011193 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011194 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011195
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011196defer-accept
11197 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11198 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11199 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011200 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011201 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11202 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11203 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11204 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11205 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11206 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11207 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11208
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011209expose-fd listeners
11210 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11211 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011212 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11213 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011214 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011215
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011216force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011217 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011218 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011219 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011220 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011221
11222force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011223 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011224 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011225 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011226
11227force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011228 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011229 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011230 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011231
11232force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011233 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011234 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011235 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011236
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011237force-tlsv13
11238 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11239 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011240 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011241
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011242generate-certificates
11243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11244 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11245 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11246 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11247 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11248 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11249 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11250 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11251 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11252 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11253 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11254
11255 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11256 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011257 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011258 certificate is used many times.
11259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011260gid <gid>
11261 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11262 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11263 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11264 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11265 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11266
11267group <group>
11268 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11269 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11270 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11271 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11272 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11273
11274id <id>
11275 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11276 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11277 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11278 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11279
11280interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011281 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11282 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11283 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11284 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11285 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11286 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011287 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11288 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11289 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11290 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11291 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11292 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011293
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011294level <level>
11295 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11296 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11297 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011298 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011299 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11300 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11301 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011303 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011305 all counters).
11306
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011307severity-output <format>
11308 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11309 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11310 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11311 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11312 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11313 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11314 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11315 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11316 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11317 rfc5424 convention.
11318
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011319maxconn <maxconn>
11320 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11321 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11322 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11323 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11324 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11325 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11326 eat all memory.
11327
11328mode <mode>
11329 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11330 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11331 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11332 UNIX sockets.
11333
11334mss <maxseg>
11335 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11336 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11337 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11338 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11339 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11340 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11341 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11342 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11343 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11344 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11345 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11346
11347name <name>
11348 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11349 page.
11350
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011351namespace <name>
11352 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11353 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11354 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11355 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11356
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011357nice <nice>
11358 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11359 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11360 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11361 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11362 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11363 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11364 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11365 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11366 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11367 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11368 one for an RDP socket.
11369
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011370no-ca-names
11371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11372 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11373
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011374no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011375 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011376 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011377 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011378 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011379 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11380 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011381
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011382no-tls-tickets
11383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11384 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11385 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011386 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11387 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011388
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011389no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011391 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011392 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011393 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011394 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11395 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011396
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011397no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011399 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011400 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011401 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011402 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11403 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011404
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011405no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011407 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011408 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011409 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011410 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11411 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011412
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011413no-tlsv13
11414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11415 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11416 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11417 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011418 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11419 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011420
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011421npn <protocols>
11422 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11423 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11424 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11425 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011426 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011427 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11428 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11429 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11430 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11431 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011432
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011433prefer-client-ciphers
11434 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11435 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11436 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011437 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11438 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11439 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011440
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011441process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011442 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011443 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011444 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011445 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11446 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11447 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11448 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011449 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011450 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11451 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11452 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11453 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11454 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011455
11456 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11457
11458 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11459 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11460 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11461 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11462 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11463 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11464 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11465 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011466
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011467proto <name>
11468 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11469 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11470 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11471 in haproxy -vv.
11472 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11473 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011474 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011475 h2" on the bind line.
11476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011477ssl
11478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011479 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011480 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11481 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011482 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11483 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011484
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011485ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11486 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11487 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11488 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11489
11490ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11491 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11492 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11493 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11494
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011495strict-sni
11496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11497 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11498 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11499 See the "crt" option for more information.
11500
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011501tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011502 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011503 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11504 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011506 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11507 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11508 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11509 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11510 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11511 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11512 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11513
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011514tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011515 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011516 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11517 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11518 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11519 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11520 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11521 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11522 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011523 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11524 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11525 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011526
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011527tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11528 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011529 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11530 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11531 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11532 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11533 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11534 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11535 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11536 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11537 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11538 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011539 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11540 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11541
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011542transparent
11543 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11544 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11545 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11546 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11547 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11548 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11549 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11550 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11551 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11552 so check for support with your vendor.
11553
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011554v4v6
11555 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11556 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11557 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11558 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011559 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011560
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011561v6only
11562 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11563 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11564 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011565 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11566 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011567
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011568uid <uid>
11569 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11570 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11571 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11572 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11573 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11574
11575user <user>
11576 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11577 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11578 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11579 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11580 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11581
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011582verify [none|optional|required]
11583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11584 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11585 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11586 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11587 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011588 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11589 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11590 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11591 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011592
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200115935.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011594------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011596The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11597which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11598arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11599settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11600after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11601Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11602address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011604 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011605 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011606
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011607Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11608keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011610The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011611
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011612addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011613 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011614 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11615 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11616 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11617 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11618 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011619
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011620agent-check
11621 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011622 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011623 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11624 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11625 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011626
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011627 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011628 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011629 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11630 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11631 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011632
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011633 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11634 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11635 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11636 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11637 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011639 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011640 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011641
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011642 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11643 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11644 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011645
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011646 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11647 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11648 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011649
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011650 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11651 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11652 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11653 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11654 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011655 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011656 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011657
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011658 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11659 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011660
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011661 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11662 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11663 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11664 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11665 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11666 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11667 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11668 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11669 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011670
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011671 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11672 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011673 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11674 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11675 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011676 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011677
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011678 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011679 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011680
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011681agent-send <string>
11682 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11683 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11684 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11685 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11686 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11687
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011688agent-inter <delay>
11689 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11690 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11691
11692 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11693 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11694 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11695 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11696 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11697 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11698 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11699 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11700 of backends use the same servers.
11701
11702 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11703
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011704agent-addr <addr>
11705 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11706
11707 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11708 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11709 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11710 hostname, it will be resolved.
11711
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011712agent-port <port>
11713 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11714
11715 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11716
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011717allow-0rtt
11718 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011719 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11720 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011721
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011722alpn <protocols>
11723 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11724 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11725 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11726 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11727 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11728 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11729 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11730 now obsolete NPN extension.
11731 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11732 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11733
11734 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011736backup
11737 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11738 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11739 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11740 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011741 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11742 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011743
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011744ca-file <cafile>
11745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11746 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11747 server's certificate.
11748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011749check
11750 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011751 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11752 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11753 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11754 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11755 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11756 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11757 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011758 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11759 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011760 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11761 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011762
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011763check-send-proxy
11764 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11765 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11766 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11767 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11768 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11769 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11770 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11771
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011772check-alpn <protocols>
11773 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11774 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11775 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11776
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011777check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011778 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011779 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11780 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011781
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011782check-ssl
11783 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11784 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11785 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11786 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011787 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011788 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11789 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011790 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011791 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11792 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011793
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011794check-via-socks4
11795 This option enables outgoinng health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
11796 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11797 for normal traffic.
11798
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011799ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11801 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11802 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011803 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11804 information and recommendations see e.g.
11805 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11806 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11807 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011808
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011809ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11811 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11812 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11813 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011814 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11815 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11816 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011818cookie <value>
11819 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11820 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11821 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11822 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11823 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11824 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11825 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11826
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011827crl-file <crlfile>
11828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11829 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11830 to verify server's certificate.
11831
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011832crt <cert>
11833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11834 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11835 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11836 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11837 certificate request.
11838
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011839disabled
11840 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11841 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11842 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11843 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11844 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011845 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011846
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011847enabled
11848 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11849 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11850 default value.
11851 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11852 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011854error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011855 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11856 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11857 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011859 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011861fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011862 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11863 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11864 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11865
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011866force-sslv3
11867 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11868 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011869 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011870 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011871
11872force-tlsv10
11873 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011874 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011875 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011876
11877force-tlsv11
11878 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011879 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011880 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011881
11882force-tlsv12
11883 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011884 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011885 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011886
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011887force-tlsv13
11888 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11889 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011890 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011892id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011893 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11894 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11895 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011896
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011897init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11898 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11899 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011900 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011901 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11902 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11903 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11904 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11905 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11906 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11907 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11908 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11909 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011910 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011911 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11912 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11913 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11914 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11915 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11916 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011917 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011918
11919 Example:
11920 defaults
11921 # never fail on address resolution
11922 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011924inter <delay>
11925fastinter <delay>
11926downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011927 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11928 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11929 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11930 between checks depending on the server state :
11931
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011932 Server state | Interval used
11933 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11934 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11935 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11936 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11937 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11938 or yet unchecked. |
11939 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11940 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11941 | "inter" otherwise.
11942 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011944 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11945 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11946 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11947 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011948 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11949 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11950 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11951 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11952 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011954maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011955 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11956 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11957 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11958 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11959 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11960 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11961 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11962 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011964maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011965 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11966 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11967 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11968 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11969 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11970 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11971 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11972
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011973max-reuse <count>
11974 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11975 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11976 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11977 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11978 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11979 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11980 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11981 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011983minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011984 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11985 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11986 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11987 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11988 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11989 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011990 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011991 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011992
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011993namespace <name>
11994 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11995 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11996 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11997 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11998
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011999no-agent-check
12000 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12001 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12002 default value.
12003 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12004 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12005
12006no-backup
12007 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12008 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12009 default value.
12010 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12011 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12012
12013no-check
12014 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12015 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12016 default value.
12017 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12018 "default-server" "check" setting.
12019
12020no-check-ssl
12021 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12022 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12023 default value.
12024 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12025 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12026
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012027no-send-proxy
12028 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12029 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12030 default value.
12031 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12032 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12033
12034no-send-proxy-v2
12035 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12036 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12037 default value.
12038 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12039 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12040
12041no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12042 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12043 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12044 default value.
12045 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12046 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12047
12048no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12049 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12050 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12051 default value.
12052 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12053 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12054
12055no-ssl
12056 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12057 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12058 default value.
12059 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12060 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12061
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012062no-ssl-reuse
12063 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12064 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12065 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12066 and for paranoid users.
12067
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012068no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012069 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12070 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012071 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012072
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012073 Supported in default-server: No
12074
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012075no-tls-tickets
12076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12077 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12078 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012079 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12080 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012081 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012082
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012083no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012084 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012085 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12086 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012087 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12088 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012089 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012090
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012091 Supported in default-server: No
12092
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012093no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012094 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012095 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12096 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012097 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12098 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012099 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012100
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012101 Supported in default-server: No
12102
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012103no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012104 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012105 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12106 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012107 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12108 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012109 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012110
12111 Supported in default-server: No
12112
12113no-tlsv13
12114 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12115 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12116 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12117 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12118 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012119 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012120
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012121 Supported in default-server: No
12122
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012123no-verifyhost
12124 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12125 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12126 default value.
12127 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12128 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012129
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012130non-stick
12131 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12132 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12133 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12134
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012135npn <protocols>
12136 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12137 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12138 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12139 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12140 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12141 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12142 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012144observe <mode>
12145 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12146 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12147 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12148 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12149 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12150 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012151 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012152
12153 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012155on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012156 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12157 Currently, four modes are available:
12158 - fastinter: force fastinter
12159 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12160 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12161 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12162 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12163
12164 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12165
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012166on-marked-down <action>
12167 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12168 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012169 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12170 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12171 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12172 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12173 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12174 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12175 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12176 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012177
12178 Actions are disabled by default
12179
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012180on-marked-up <action>
12181 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12182 Currently one action is available:
12183 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12184 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12185 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12186 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012187 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12188 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012189 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12190 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12191
12192 Actions are disabled by default
12193
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012194pool-max-conn <max>
12195 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12196 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12197 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12198 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12199 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12200 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12201
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012202pool-purge-delay <delay>
12203 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012204 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012205 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012207port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012208 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12209 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12210 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12211 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12212 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12213 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12214
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012215proto <name>
12216
12217 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12218 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12219 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12220 reported in haproxy -vv.
12221 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12222 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012224redir <prefix>
12225 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12226 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12227 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12228 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12229 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12230 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12231 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12232 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012233 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012234 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012235 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12236 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12237 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12238 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12239
12240 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012242rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012243 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12244 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12245 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12246
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012247resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12248 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12249 server.
12250
12251 Available options:
12252
12253 * allow-dup-ip
12254 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12255 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12256 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12257 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12258 For such case, simply enable this option.
12259 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12260
12261 * prevent-dup-ip
12262 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12263 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12264 same fqdn.
12265 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12266
12267 Example:
12268 backend b_myapp
12269 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12270 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12271 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12272
12273 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12274 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12275 it
12276 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12277 different address
12278
12279 Default value: not set
12280
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012281resolve-prefer <family>
12282 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12283 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12284 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12285 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12286
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012287 Default value: ipv6
12288
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012289 Example:
12290
12291 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012292
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012293resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12294 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12295 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012296 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012297 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12298 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012299 configured network, another address is selected.
12300
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012301 Example:
12302
12303 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012304
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012305resolvers <id>
12306 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12307 hostname.
12308
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012309 Example:
12310
12311 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012312
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012313 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012314
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012315send-proxy
12316 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12317 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12318 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12319 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012320 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12321 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12322 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12323 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12324 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12325 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12326 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12327 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12328 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12329 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012330 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12331 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012332
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012333send-proxy-v2
12334 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12335 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12336 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12337 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012338 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12339 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12340 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12341 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012342
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012343proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12344 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12345 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012346 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12347 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012348 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12349 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012350 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012351
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012352send-proxy-v2-ssl
12353 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12354 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12355 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12356 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12357 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12358 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12359 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012360 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12361 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012362
12363send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12364 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12365 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12366 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12367 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12368 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12369 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12370 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12371 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012372 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12373 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012375slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012376 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12377 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12378 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12379 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12380 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12381 parameters :
12382
12383 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12384 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12385
12386 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12387 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12388 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12389 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12390
12391 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12392 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12393 seen as failed.
12394
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012395sni <expression>
12396 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12397 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12398 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12399 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012400 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12401 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012402 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012403 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12404 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012405
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012406source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012407source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012408source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012409 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12410 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12411 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12412 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12413
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012414 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12415 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12416 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12417 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12418 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12419 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12420 server.
12421
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012422 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12423 specifying the source address without port(s).
12424
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012425ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012426 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12427 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12428 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12429 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12430 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12431 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012432 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12433 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012434
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012435ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12436 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12437 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12438 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12439
12440ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12441 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12442 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12443 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12444
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012445ssl-reuse
12446 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12447 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12448 default value.
12449 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12450 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12451
12452stick
12453 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12454 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12455 default value.
12456 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12457 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012458
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012459socks4 <addr>:<port>
12460 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoinng connections to the
12461 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12462 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12463
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012464tcp-ut <delay>
12465 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12466 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12467 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012469 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12470 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12471 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12472 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12473 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12474 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12475 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12476 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12477 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12478
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012479tfo
12480 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12481 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12482 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12483 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12484 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12485 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12486
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012487track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012488 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12489 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12490 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12491 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012492 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12493
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012494tls-tickets
12495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12497 default value.
12498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12499 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012500
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012501verify [none|required]
12502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012503 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012504 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12505 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012506 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012507 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12508 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12509 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12510 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12511 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12512 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12513 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12514 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012515
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012516verifyhost <hostname>
12517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012518 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12519 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12520 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12521 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12522 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12523 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12524 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12525 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012527weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012528 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12529 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12530 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012531 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12532 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12533 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12534 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12535 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12536 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012537
12538
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125395.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12540-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012541
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012542HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12543using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12544configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012545This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12546can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12547workload.
12548This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12549resolution at run time.
12550Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12551carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12552
12553
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125545.3.1. Global overview
12555----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012556
12557As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12558different steps of the process life:
12559
12560 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12561 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12562 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12563
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012564 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12565 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012566
12567A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12568 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12569 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12570 resolution to know this new IP.
12571
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012572When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012573HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012574SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12575from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12576will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12577will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012578
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012579A few things important to notice:
12580 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12581 first valid response.
12582
12583 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12584 servers return an error.
12585
12586
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125875.3.2. The resolvers section
12588----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012589
12590This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012591HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12592contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012593
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012594When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12595uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12596is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12597answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12598
12599When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012600used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012601
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012602 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12603 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12604 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012605
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012606 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12607 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012608
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012609 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12610 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12611 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012612
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012613For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12614following scenarios are possible:
12615
12616 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12617 ignored
12618
12619 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12620 applied
12621
12622 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12623 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12624
12625 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12626 retries the query with a new type
12627
12628 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12629 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012630
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012631As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12632a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012633<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012634
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012635
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012636resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012637 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012638
12639A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12640
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012641accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012642 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012643 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012644 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12645 by RFC 6891)
12646
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012647 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12648
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012649nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12650 DNS server description:
12651 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12652 <ip> : IP address of the server
12653 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12654
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012655parse-resolv-conf
12656 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12657 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12658 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12659
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012660hold <status> <period>
12661 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12662 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012663 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012664 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012665 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12666 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12667 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12668
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012669 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012670
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012671resolve_retries <nb>
12672 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12673 giving up.
12674 Default value: 3
12675
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012676 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12677 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12678 type.
12679
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012680timeout <event> <time>
12681 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12682 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12683 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012684 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12685 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012686 Default value: 1s
12687 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012688 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012689 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012690 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12691 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012693 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012694
12695 resolvers mydns
12696 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12697 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012698 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012699 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012700 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012701 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012702 hold other 30s
12703 hold refused 30s
12704 hold nx 30s
12705 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012706 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012707 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012708
12709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127106. HTTP header manipulation
12711---------------------------
12712
12713In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12714response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12715request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12716which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012717against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012718
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012719If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12720to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12721but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12722HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12723stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12724because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12725a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12726still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012728This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12729in section 4.2 :
12730
12731 - reqadd <string>
12732 - reqallow <search>
12733 - reqiallow <search>
12734 - reqdel <search>
12735 - reqidel <search>
12736 - reqdeny <search>
12737 - reqideny <search>
12738 - reqpass <search>
12739 - reqipass <search>
12740 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12741 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12742 - reqtarpit <search>
12743 - reqitarpit <search>
12744 - rspadd <string>
12745 - rspdel <search>
12746 - rspidel <search>
12747 - rspdeny <search>
12748 - rspideny <search>
12749 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12750 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12751
12752With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12753is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12754parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12755prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12756Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12757
12758 \t for a tab
12759 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12760 \n for a new line (LF)
12761 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12762 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12763 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12764 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12765 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12766
12767The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12768portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12769above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12770regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
127719 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12772is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12773
12774The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12775after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12776
12777Notes related to these keywords :
12778---------------------------------
12779 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12780 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12781 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12782
12783 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12784 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12785 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12786
12787 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12788 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12789 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12790 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12791 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12792
12793 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12794 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12795 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12796 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12797 useless headers before adding new ones.
12798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012799 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012800 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12801
12802 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12803 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12804 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12805
12806 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12807 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012808 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012809
12810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128117. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12812----------------------------------
12813
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012814HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12816The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12817these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12818but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12819data called patterns.
12820
12821
128227.1. ACL basics
12823---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012824
12825The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12826content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12827from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12828simple :
12829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012831 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12833 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12836adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012837
12838In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012841
12842This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12843Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12844and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012845an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12846conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12847as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12848are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012849
12850ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12851'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12852which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12853
12854There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12855performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12858specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12859this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012860methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12861ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862
12863Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12864 - boolean
12865 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12866 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12867 - string
12868 - data block
12869
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012870Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12871converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12872would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12873The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12874which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12875
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012876Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12877keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12878fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12879which are summarized in the table below :
12880
12881 +---------------------+-----------------+
12882 | Sample or converter | Default |
12883 | output type | matching method |
12884 +---------------------+-----------------+
12885 | boolean | bool |
12886 +---------------------+-----------------+
12887 | integer | int |
12888 +---------------------+-----------------+
12889 | ip | ip |
12890 +---------------------+-----------------+
12891 | string | str |
12892 +---------------------+-----------------+
12893 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12894 +---------------------+-----------------+
12895
12896Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12897matching method, see below.
12898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12900 - boolean
12901 - integer or integer range
12902 - IP address / network
12903 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12904 - regular expression
12905 - hex block
12906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012907The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12908
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012909 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12910 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012912 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012913 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012914 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012915 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12918read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12919if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12920lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12921will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12922beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12923a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12924lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12925exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12926
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012927The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12928parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12929ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12930a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12931check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12932
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012933The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12934socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12935file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12938loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12939
12940 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12941
12942In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12943the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12944case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12945as well.
12946
12947The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12948sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12949do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12950methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12951is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012952obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12954default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12955that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12956string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12957
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012958The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12959By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12960string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12961resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12962server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12963waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12964flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12965function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012967There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12968sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12969be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012970
12971 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12972 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012973 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12974 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12975 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12976 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012977
12978 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12979 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012981
12982 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012983 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012984
12985 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012987
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012989 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12990
12991 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12992 binary or string samples.
12993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12995 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012997 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12998 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12999 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13002 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13005 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013007 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13008 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13011 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013012 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13015 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13016 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013017
13018For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13019request, it is possible to do :
13020
13021 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13022
13023In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13024buffer, one would use the following acl :
13025
13026 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13027
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013028On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13029possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13030
13031 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13034criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13035method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13036to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13037criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13038the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013041the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13042For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013044 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13045 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13046 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13047 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013048
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013049
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013050The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13051types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13052combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13053brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13054default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056 +-------------------------------------------------+
13057 | Input sample type |
13058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013059 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13061 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013063 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013065 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013067 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013069 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013071 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013072 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013073 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013075 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013076 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013077 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013078 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013079 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013080 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013081 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013083 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13085 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13086 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013087
13088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130897.1.1. Matching booleans
13090------------------------
13091
13092In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13093Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13094When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13095that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13096
13097Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13098return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13099"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13100
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131027.1.2. Matching integers
13103------------------------
13104
13105Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13106enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13107to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13108
13109Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13110matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13111lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013112
13113For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13114unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13115representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13116
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013117As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13118two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13119instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13120ranges and operators.
13121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013122For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013123operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13124Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13125of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013127Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013128
13129 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13130 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13131 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13132 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13133 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013135For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013136
13137 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13138
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013139This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13140
13141 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13142
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131447.1.3. Matching strings
13145-----------------------
13146
13147String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13148different forms :
13149
13150 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013151 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152
13153 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013154 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155
13156 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13157 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13158
13159 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13160 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13161
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013162 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13164 matches.
13165
13166 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13167 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13168 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013169
13170String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13171exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13172characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13173string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13174to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013175before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013176
13177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13179---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013180
13181Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13182they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13183possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13184passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13185the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013186the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13187match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013188
13189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131907.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13191-------------------------------------
13192
13193It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13194not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13195a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13196to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13197digits may be used upper or lower case.
13198
13199Example :
13200 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13201 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13202
13203
132047.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13205---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013206
13207IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13208netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13209within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013210host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013211difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13212at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13213does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13214parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013215
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013216The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13217abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13218
13219 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13220 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13221 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13222 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13223 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13224 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13225 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13226 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13227
13228Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13229192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13230
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013231IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13232Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13233trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13234IPv6 patterns.
13235
13236HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13237following situations :
13238 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13239 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13240 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13241 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13242 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13243 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13244 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13245 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13246 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13247 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249
132507.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13251----------------------------------
13252
13253Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13254combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13255
13256 - AND (implicit)
13257 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13258 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013260A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13265indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13268"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13269requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13270is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13271
13272 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013273 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13274 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13275 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276
13277To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13278and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13279
13280 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13281 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13282 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13283 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13284
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013285 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13287 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13288 use_backend www if host_www
13289
13290It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13291expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13292be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13293the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13294
13295 The following rule :
13296
13297 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013298 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013299
13300 Can also be written that way :
13301
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013302 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013303
13304It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13305to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13306simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13307sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13308good use is the following :
13309
13310 With named ACLs :
13311
13312 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13313 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13314 monitor fail if site_dead
13315
13316 With anonymous ACLs :
13317
13318 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13319
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013320See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13321keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322
13323
133247.3. Fetching samples
13325---------------------
13326
13327Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13328against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13329sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13330ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13331of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13332available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13333
13334This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13335Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13336compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13337deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13338
13339The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13340matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13341method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13342indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13343
13344As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13345when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13346mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13347the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13348ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13349
13350Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13351multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13352when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13354are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13356all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13357
13358Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13359 - name
13360 - name(arg1)
13361 - name(arg1,arg2)
13362
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013363
133647.3.1. Converters
13365-----------------
13366
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013367Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13368of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13369is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13370was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013371has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013372unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13373
13374These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13375sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13376the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013377support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013378
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013379A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13380support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13381supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13382(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13383bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013385The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013386
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001338751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13388 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13389 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13390 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13391 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13392 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13393
13394 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013395 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13396 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013397 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13398 frontend http-in
13399 bind *:8081
13400 default_backend servers
13401 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13402 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13403
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013404add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013405 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013406 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013407 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13408 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013409 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013410 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13411 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13413 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013414 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013415 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013416
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013417aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13418 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13419 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13420 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13421 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13422 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13423 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13424
13425 Example:
13426 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13427 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13428
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013429and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013430 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013431 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013432 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13433 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013434 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013435 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13436 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013441
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013442b64dec
13443 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13444 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13445
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013446base64
13447 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013449 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13450
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013451bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013452 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013453 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013455 presence of a flag).
13456
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013457bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13458 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13459 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013460 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013461
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013462concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13463 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13464 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13465 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13466 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13467 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13468 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13469 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13470 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13471 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13472 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13473 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13474 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13475 delimitors.
13476
13477 Example:
13478 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13479 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13480 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13481 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13482
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013483cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013484 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13485 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013486
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013487crc32([<avalanche>])
13488 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13489 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13490 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13491 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13492 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13493 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13494 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13495 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13496 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13497 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013498 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13499
13500crc32c([<avalanche>])
13501 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13502 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13503 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13504 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13505 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13506 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13507 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13508 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013509
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013510da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013511 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13512 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13513 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13514 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013515 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013516 configuration language.
13517
13518 Example:
13519 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013520 bind *:8881
13521 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013522 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013523
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013524debug
13525 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13526 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13527 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13528
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013529div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013530 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13531 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013532 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013533 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13534 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013535 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013536 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13537 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13538 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13539 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013541 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013542
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013543djb2([<avalanche>])
13544 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13545 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13546 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13547 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13548 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13549 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13550 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013551 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13552 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013553
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013554even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013555 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013556 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13557
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013558field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13559 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13560 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13561 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13562 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13563 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13564 fields.
13565
13566 Example :
13567 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13568 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13569 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13570 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13571 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013573hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013574 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013575 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013576 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013577 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013578
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013579hex2i
13580 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13581 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013583http_date([<offset>])
13584 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13585 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13586 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13587 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13588 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13589 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013591in_table(<table>)
13592 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13593 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13594 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013595 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013596 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13597
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013598ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13599 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013600 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013601 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13602 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13603 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13604 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13605 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013606
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013607json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013608 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013609 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013610 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013611 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13612 of errors:
13613 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13614 bytes, ...)
13615 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13616 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13617
13618 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13619 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13620 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13621 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13622 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13623 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013624 - "ascii" : never fails;
13625 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13626 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013627 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013628 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013629 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13630 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13631
13632 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013633 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013634
13635 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013636 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013637 capture request header user-agent len 150
13638 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013639
13640 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13641 GET / HTTP/1.0
13642 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13643
13644 Output log:
13645 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13646
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013647language(<value>[,<default>])
13648 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13649 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13650 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13651 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13652 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13653 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13654 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13655 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13656 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013657 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013658 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13659 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013660
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013661 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013663 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13664 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013665
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013666 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13667 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13668 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13669 use_backend spanish if es
13670 use_backend french if fr
13671 use_backend english if en
13672 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013673
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013674length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013675 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13676 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13677 type. The result is of type integer.
13678
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013679lower
13680 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13681 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13682 type. The result is of type string.
13683
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013684ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13685 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13686 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13687 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13688 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13689 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13690 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13691
13692 Example :
13693
13694 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013695 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013696 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013698map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13699map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13700map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13701 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13702 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13703 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13704 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13705 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13706 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13707 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13708 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013710 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13711 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13712 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013713
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013714 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013715 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013716
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013717 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13718 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13719 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13720 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013721 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13722 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013723 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13724 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13725 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13726 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13727 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13728 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13729 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13730 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013731 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13732 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13733 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013734 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13735 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13736 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13737 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13738 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013739
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013740 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13741 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13742 the corresponding match text.
13743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013744 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13745 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13746 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13747 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13748 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013750 Example :
13751
13752 # this is a comment and is ignored
13753 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13754 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13755 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13756 | | | `---------- value
13757 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13758 | `---------------------------- key
13759 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13760
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013761mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013762 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13763 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013764 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013765 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013766 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013767 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13768 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13769 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13770 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013772 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013773
13774mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013775 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013776 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13777 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013778 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013779 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013780 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013781 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13782 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13784 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013787
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013788nbsrv
13789 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13790 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13791 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13792 map lookup.
13793
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013794neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013795 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13796 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13797 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13798 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013799
13800not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013801 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013802 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013803 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013804 absence of a flag).
13805
13806odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013807 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013808 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13809
13810or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013811 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013812 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013813 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13814 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013815 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013821 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013822
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013823protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13824 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13825 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13826 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13827 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13828 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13829 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13830 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13831 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13832 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13833 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13834 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13835
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013836regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013837 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13838 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13839 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13840 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13841 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13842 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13843 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13844 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13845 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13846 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013847 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13848 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13849 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13850 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013851
13852 Example :
13853
13854 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13855 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13856 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13857 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13858
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013859capture-req(<id>)
13860 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13861 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13862
13863 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013864 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13865 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013866
13867capture-res(<id>)
13868 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13869 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13870
13871 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013872 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13873 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013874
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013875sdbm([<avalanche>])
13876 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13877 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13878 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13879 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13880 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13881 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13882 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013883 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13884 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013886set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013887 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13888 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13889 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013890 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013891 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13892 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013893 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013894 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13895 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013897 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013898
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013899sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013900 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013901 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13902
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013903sha2([<bits>])
13904 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13905 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13906
13907 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13908 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13909
13910 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13911 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13912
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013913strcmp(<var>)
13914 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13915 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13916 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13917 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13918 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13919 shorter).
13920
13921 Example :
13922
13923 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13924 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13925 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13926
13927
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013928sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013929 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13930 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013931 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013932 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13933 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013934 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013935 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13936 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013937 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013938 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13939 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013940 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013941 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013942
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013943table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13944 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13945 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13946 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13947 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13948 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13949 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13950
13951
13952table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13956 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13957 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13958 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13959
13960table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13961 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13962 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013963 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013964 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13965 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13966
13967table_conn_cur(<table>)
13968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13971 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13972 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13973
13974table_conn_rate(<table>)
13975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13978 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13979 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13980
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013981table_gpt0(<table>)
13982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13985 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13986 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13987
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013988table_gpc0(<table>)
13989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13992 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13993 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13994
13995table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13996 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13997 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13998 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13999 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14000 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14001 sample fetch keyword.
14002
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014003table_gpc1(<table>)
14004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14007 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14008 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14009
14010table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14014 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14015 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14016 sample fetch keyword.
14017
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014018table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014022 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14023 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14024
14025table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14026 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14027 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14028 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14029 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14030 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14031 keyword.
14032
14033table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014037 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14038 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14039
14040table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14043 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14044 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14045 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14046 keyword.
14047
14048table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014052 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14053 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14054 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14055 keyword.
14056
14057table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014060 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014061 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14062 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14063 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14064 keyword.
14065
14066table_server_id(<table>)
14067 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14068 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14069 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14070 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14071 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14072 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14073
14074table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014078 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14079 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14080 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14081 keyword.
14082
14083table_sess_rate(<table>)
14084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14087 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14088 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14089 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14090 keyword.
14091
14092table_trackers(<table>)
14093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14096 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14097 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14098 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14099 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14100 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14101 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14102 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14103
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014104upper
14105 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14106 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14107 type. The result is of type string.
14108
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014109url_dec
14110 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14111 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14112
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014113ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014114 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014115 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14116 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14117 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014118 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14119 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14120 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14121 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014122 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014123 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14124 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014125
14126 Example:
14127 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14128 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14129
14130 message Point {
14131 int32 latitude = 1;
14132 int32 longitude = 2;
14133 }
14134
14135 message PPoint {
14136 Point point = 59;
14137 }
14138
14139 message Rectangle {
14140 // One corner of the rectangle.
14141 PPoint lo = 48;
14142 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14143 PPoint hi = 49;
14144 }
14145
14146 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14147 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14148 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14149
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014150 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14151 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14152 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14153 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14154
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014155 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014156
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014157 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014158
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014159 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14160 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14161 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14162
14163 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14164 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14165 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14166
14167 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14168 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14169 interpret the previous binary sample.
14170
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014171
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014172unset-var(<var name>)
14173 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14174 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14175 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14176 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14177 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14178 response),
14179 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14180 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14181 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14182 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14183
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014184utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14185 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14186 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14187 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14188 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14189 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14190 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14191
14192 Example :
14193
14194 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014195 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014196 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14197
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014198word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14199 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14200 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14201 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14202 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14203 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14204
14205 Example :
14206 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14207 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14208 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14209 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14210 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014211
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014212wt6([<avalanche>])
14213 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14214 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14215 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14216 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14217 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14218 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14219 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014220 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14221 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014222
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014223xor(<value>)
14224 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014225 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014226 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014227 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014228 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014229 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14230 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014231 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014232 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14233 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014234 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014235 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014236
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014237xxh32([<seed>])
14238 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14239 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14240 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14241 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14242 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14243 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14244 as cryptographically secure.
14245
14246xxh64([<seed>])
14247 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14248 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14249 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14250 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14251 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14252 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14253 as cryptographically secure.
14254
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257--------------------------------------------
14258
14259A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14260not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14261"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14262The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14263
14264always_false : boolean
14265 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14266 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14267
14268always_true : boolean
14269 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14270 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14271
14272avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014273 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14275 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14276 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14277 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14278 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14279 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14280 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14281 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14282 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14283 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14284 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14285 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14286 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014289 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14290 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14291 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14292 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014293 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14294
14295be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14296 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14297 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14298 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14299 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14300 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014301 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14302 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014303
14304 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14305 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14306 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14309 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14310 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14311 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014312 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14314 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014315
14316 Example :
14317 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14318 backend dynamic
14319 mode http
14320 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14321 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014322
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014323bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014324 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14325 of the string.
14326
14327bool(<bool>) : bool
14328 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14329 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014333 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14335 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014336
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014337 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014338 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014339 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14340
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014341 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14342 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014343
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014344 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014345 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014347 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014348 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014350 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014352 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14353 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014355 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014356
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014357cpu_calls : integer
14358 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14359 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14360 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14361 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14362 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14363 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14364
14365cpu_ns_avg : integer
14366 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14367 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14368 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14369 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14370 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14371 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14372 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14373 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14374 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14375 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14376 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14377
14378cpu_ns_tot : integer
14379 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14380 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14381 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14382 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14383 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14384 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14385 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14386 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14387 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14388 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14389 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14390 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14391 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14392
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014393date([<offset>]) : integer
14394 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14395 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14396 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14397 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014398 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14399
14400 Example :
14401
14402 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14403 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014404
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014405date_us : integer
14406 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14407 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14408 from the same timeval structure.
14409
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014410distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14411 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14412 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14413 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14414 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14415 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14416 list of supported tokens.
14417
14418distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14419 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14420 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14421 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14422 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14423 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14424 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14425 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14426 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14427 supported tokens.
14428
14429 Example :
14430 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14431 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14432 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14433 # send large files to the big farm
14434 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14435
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014436env(<name>) : string
14437 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14438 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14439 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14440 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14441 certain way.
14442
14443 Examples :
14444 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14445 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14446
14447 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14448 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14451 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014452 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14453 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14455 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014456 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014457 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14458 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014459
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014460fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14461 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14462 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14463 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14467 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14468 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14469 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14470 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14471 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14472 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14473 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014474
14475 Example :
14476 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14477 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14478 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14479 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14480 frontend mail
14481 bind :25
14482 mode tcp
14483 maxconn 100
14484 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14485 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14486 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14487 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014488
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014489hostname : string
14490 Returns the system hostname.
14491
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014492int(<integer>) : signed integer
14493 Returns a signed integer.
14494
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014495ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14496 Returns an ipv4.
14497
14498ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14499 Returns an ipv6.
14500
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014501lat_ns_avg : integer
14502 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14503 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14504 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14505 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14506 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14507 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14508 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14509 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14510 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14511 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14512 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14513 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14514 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14515 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14516
14517lat_ns_tot : integer
14518 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14519 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14520 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14521 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14522 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14523 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14524 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14525 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14526 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14527 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14528 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14529 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14530 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14531 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14532 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14533 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14534 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14535 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14536 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14537
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014538meth(<method>) : method
14539 Returns a method.
14540
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014541nbproc : integer
14542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14543 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14544 and debugging purposes.
14545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14548 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14549 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014550 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14551 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14552 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014553
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014554prio_class : integer
14555 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14556 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14557 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14558
14559prio_offset : integer
14560 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14561 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14562 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14563 set-priority-offset".
14564
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014565proc : integer
14566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14567 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14568 debugging purposes.
14569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014571 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14572 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14573 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14575 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14576 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14577 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14578 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14579
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014580rand([<range>]) : integer
14581 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14582 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14583 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14584 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14585 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14589 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14590 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14591 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14592 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014593 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14594 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14595
14596srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14598 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14599 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14600 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14601 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14602 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14603 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14604
14605 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14606 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607
14608srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14609 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14610 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14611 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014612 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14614 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14615 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14616
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014617srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14619 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14620 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14621 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14622 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14623 fetch methods.
14624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014625srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14626 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14627 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014628 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14630 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014631 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014632 overloading servers).
14633
14634 Example :
14635 # Redirect to a separate back
14636 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14637 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14638 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14639
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014640stopping : boolean
14641 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14642 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14643 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14644
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014645str(<string>) : string
14646 Returns a string.
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14649 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14650 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14651
14652table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14653 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14654 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14655 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14656
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014657thread : integer
14658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14659 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14660 and debugging purposes.
14661
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014662var(<var-name>) : undefined
14663 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014664 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14665 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014666 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014667 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14668 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014669 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014674
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146757.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676----------------------------------
14677
14678The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14679closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14680methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14681sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14682TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014683the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14684counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014685"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14686used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14687can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14688Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14689table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14690tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14691currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014692
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014693bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014694 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14695 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14696 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014698be_id : integer
14699 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14700 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14701
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014702be_name : string
14703 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14704 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014706dst : ip
14707 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14708 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14709 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14710 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014711 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14712 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14713 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14714 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14715 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14716 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014717
14718dst_conn : integer
14719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14720 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14721 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14722 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14723 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14724 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14725 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14726 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014727
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014728dst_is_local : boolean
14729 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14730 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14731 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14732 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014733 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014734 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14735 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14736 it only once per connection.
14737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014738dst_port : integer
14739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14740 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14741 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14742 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14743 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14744 an HTTP header.
14745
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014746fc_http_major : integer
14747 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14748 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14749 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14750
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014751fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14752 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14753 header.
14754
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014755fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14756 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14757 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14758 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14759 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14760 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14761 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14762
14763fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14764 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14765 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14766 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14767 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14768 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14769 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14770
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014771fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14772 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14773 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14774 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14775 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14776
14777fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14778 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14779 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14780 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14781 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14782
14783fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14784 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14785 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14786 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14787 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14788
14789fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14790 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14791 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14792 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14793 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14794
14795fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14796 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14797 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14798 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14799 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14800
14801fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14802 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14803 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14804 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14805 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14806
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014807fe_defbe : string
14808 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14809 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811fe_id : integer
14812 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014813 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14815
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014816fe_name : string
14817 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14818 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14819 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014821sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014822sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14824sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014825 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14826 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14827 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14828
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014829sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014830sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14831sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14832sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014833 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14834 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14835 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14836
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014837sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014838sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14839sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14840sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014841 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14842 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014843 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14844 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14845 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014846
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014847 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014848 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14849 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014850 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14851 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14852 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014853 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14854 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14855
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014856sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14857sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14858sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14859sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14860 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14861 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14862 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14863 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14864 when a first ACL was verified.
14865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014866sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014867sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14868sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14869sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014870 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014871 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14872
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014873sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014874sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14875sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14876sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014877 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14878 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14879 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14880
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014881sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014882sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14883sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14884sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014885 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14886 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14887 See also src_conn_rate.
14888
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014889sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014890sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14891sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14892sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014893 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014894 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014895
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014896sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14897sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14898sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14899sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14900 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14901 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14902
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014903sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14904sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14905sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14906sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14907 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14908 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014910sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014911sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14912sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014914 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14915 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14916 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014917 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14918 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14919 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014920
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014921sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14922sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14923sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14924sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14925 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14926 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14927 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14928 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14929 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14930 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14931
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014932sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014933sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14934sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14935sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014937 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14938 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014940sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014941sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14942sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14943sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014944 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14945 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14946 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14947 src_http_err_rate.
14948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014949sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014950sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14951sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14952sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014954 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14955 src_http_req_cnt.
14956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014957sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014958sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14959sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14960sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014961 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14962 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14963 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14964 src_http_req_rate.
14965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014966sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014967sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14968sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14969sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014970 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014971 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14972 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14973 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14974 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014975
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014976 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014977 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14978 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014979 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14980
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014981sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14982sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14983sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14984sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14985 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14986 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14987 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14988 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14989 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014991sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014992sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14993sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14994sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014995 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14996 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14997 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014998
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014999sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015000sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15001sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15002sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015003 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15004 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15005 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015006
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015007sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015008sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15009sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15010sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015011 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015012 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15013 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15014 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015015 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015016 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15017
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015018sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015019sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15020sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15021sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015022 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15023 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15024 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15025 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15026 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015027 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015028
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015029sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015030sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15031sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15032sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015033 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15034 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15035 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15036
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015037sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015038sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15039sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15040sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015041 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15042 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015043 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015044 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15045 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15047 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15048 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050so_id : integer
15051 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15052 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15053 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015055src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015056 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15058 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15059 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015060 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15061 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15062 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015063 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15064 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15065 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15066 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15067 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15068 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15069 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015070
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015071 Example:
15072 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15073 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015075src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15076 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15077 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15078 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015079 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015081src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15082 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15083 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015084 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015085 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15088 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15089 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15090 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15091 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15092 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15093 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015094
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015095 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015096 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15097 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15098 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15099 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015100 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015101 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15102 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15103
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015104src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15105 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15106 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15107 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15108 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15109 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15110 was verified.
15111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015113 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015115 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015116 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015119 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15121 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015122 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15125 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15126 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15127 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015128 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015131 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015133 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015134 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015135
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015136src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15137 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15138 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15139 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15140 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15141
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015142src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15143 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15144 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15145 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15146 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015149 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015150 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015151 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15152 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015153 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15154 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15155 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015156
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015157src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15158 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15159 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15160 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15161 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15162 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15163 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15164 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015167 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015169 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015170 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15174 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15175 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15176 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15177 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015178 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015181 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15183 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015184 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15187 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15188 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15189 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015190 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015191 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15194 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15195 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15196 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015197 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15199 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015200
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015201 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015202 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015203 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015204 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015205
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015206src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15207 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15208 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15209 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15210 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15211 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15212 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15213
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015214src_is_local : boolean
15215 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15216 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15217 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15218 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015219 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015220 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15221 once per connection.
15222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015224 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15225 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15226 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15227 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15228 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015231 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15232 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15233 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15234 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15235 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237src_port : integer
15238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15239 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15240 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15241 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015244 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015245 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15246 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15247 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015248 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15251 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15252 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15253 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15254 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015255 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15258 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15259 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15260 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15261 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15262 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15263 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15264 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15265 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015266
15267 Example :
15268 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15269 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15270 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15271 listen ssh
15272 bind :22
15273 mode tcp
15274 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015275 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015277 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279srv_id : integer
15280 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15281 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15282 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015283
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152847.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015287The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15288closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15289when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15290usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015291future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015292
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001529351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15294 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15295 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15296 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15297 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15298 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15299
15300 Example :
15301 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15302 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15303 # the request.
15304 frontend http-in
15305 bind *:8081
15306 default_backend servers
15307 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15308 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15309
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015310ssl_bc : boolean
15311 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15312 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15313 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15314
15315ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15316 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15317 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15318
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015319ssl_bc_alpn : string
15320 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15321 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015322 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015323 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15324 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15325 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15326 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15327 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15328 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15329
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015330ssl_bc_cipher : string
15331 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15332 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15333
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015334ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15335 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15336 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15337 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15338
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015339ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15340 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15341 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15342 session or a TLS ticket.
15343
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015344ssl_bc_npn : string
15345 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15346 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015347 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015348 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15349 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15350 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15351 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15352 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15353
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015354ssl_bc_protocol : string
15355 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15356 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15357
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015358ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015359 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015360 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15361 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015362
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015363ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15364 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15365 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15366 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15367
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015368ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15369 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15370 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15371 if session was reused or not.
15372
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015373ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15374 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15375 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15376 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15377 BoringSSL.
15378
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015379ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15380 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15381 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15384 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15385 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15386 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15387 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15388 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015390ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15391 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15392 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15393 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15394 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015395
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015396ssl_c_der : binary
15397 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15398 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15399 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401ssl_c_err : integer
15402 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15403 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15404 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15405 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15406 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15409 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15410 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15411 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15412 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15413 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15414 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15415 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15416 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418ssl_c_key_alg : string
15419 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15420 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15421 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423ssl_c_notafter : string
15424 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15425 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15426 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015428ssl_c_notbefore : string
15429 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15430 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15431 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015433ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15434 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15435 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15436 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15437 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15438 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15439 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15440 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15441 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443ssl_c_serial : binary
15444 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15445 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15446 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15449 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15450 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15451 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015452 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15453 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15454
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015455 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015456 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15459 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15460 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15461 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463ssl_c_used : boolean
15464 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15465 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467ssl_c_verify : integer
15468 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15469 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15470 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15471 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473ssl_c_version : integer
15474 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15475 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015476
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015477ssl_f_der : binary
15478 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15479 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15480 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15483 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15484 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15485 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15486 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015487 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15489 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15490 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492ssl_f_key_alg : string
15493 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15494 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15495 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497ssl_f_notafter : string
15498 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15499 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15500 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502ssl_f_notbefore : string
15503 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15504 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15505 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15508 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15509 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15510 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15511 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15512 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15513 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15514 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15515 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517ssl_f_serial : binary
15518 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15519 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15520 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015521
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015522ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15523 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15524 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15525 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15528 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15529 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15530 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532ssl_f_version : integer
15533 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15534 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15535
15536ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015537 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15538 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15539 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541 Example :
15542 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15543 listen http-https
15544 bind :80
15545 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15546 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15547
15548ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15549 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15550 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15551
15552ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015553 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015554 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15555 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15556 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15557 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15558 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15559 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15560 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15561 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563ssl_fc_cipher : string
15564 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15565 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015566
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015567ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15568 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15569 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015570 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015571
15572ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15573 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15574 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015575 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015576
15577ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15578 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15579 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15580 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015581 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015582 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015583
15584ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15585 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15586 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015587 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015588
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015589ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15590 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15591 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15592 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015595 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15596 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015597 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15598 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15599 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15600 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015601
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015602ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15603 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15604 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15605 wait until the handshake happened.
15606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15608 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015609 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15610 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15611 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15612 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015613
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015614ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015615 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015616 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15617 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015620 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15622 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15623 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15624 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15625 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15626 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15627 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629ssl_fc_protocol : string
15630 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15631 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015632
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015633ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015634 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015635 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15636 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015637
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015638ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15639 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15640 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15641 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15644 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15645 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15646 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15647 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015648
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015649ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15650 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15651 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15652 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15653 BoringSSL.
15654
15655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656ssl_fc_sni : string
15657 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15658 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15659 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15660 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15661 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15662
15663 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15664 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15665 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015666 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15667 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15671 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15674 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15675 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015676
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015677
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156787.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15682sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15683only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15684For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15685be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15686can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15687sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15688for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15689content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015692 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15694 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15697 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015698 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015700
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015701req.hdrs : string
15702 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15703 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15704 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15705 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15706
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015707req.hdrs_bin : binary
15708 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15709 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15710 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15711 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15712 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15713 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15714
15715 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15716
15717 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15718 str: <int:length><bytes>
15719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720req.len : integer
15721req_len : integer (deprecated)
15722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15723 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15724 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15725 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15726 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15727 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15728 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15729 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15732 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015733 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15734 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15735 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15736 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 ACL alternatives :
15739 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15742 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15743 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15744 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15745 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 ACL alternatives :
15748 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752req.proto_http : boolean
15753req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15754 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15755 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15756 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15757 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15758 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15759 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15760 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 Example:
15763 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15764 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15765 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015766 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15769rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15770 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15771 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15772 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15773 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15774 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15775 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15776 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15779 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15780 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15781 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15782 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15783 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785 ACL derivatives :
15786 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 Example :
15789 listen tse-farm
15790 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15791 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15792 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15793 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15794 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15795 persist rdp-cookie
15796 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15797 # This is only useful makes sense if
15798 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15799 stick-table type string size 204800
15800 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15801 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15802 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15805 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015807req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15808rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15809 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15810 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15811 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15812 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 ACL derivatives :
15815 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015816
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015817req.ssl_alpn : string
15818 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15819 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15820 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15821 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15822 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15823 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015824 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015825
15826 Examples :
15827 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15828 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15829 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015830 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015831 default_backend bk_default
15832
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015833req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15834 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15835 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015836 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15837 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15838 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15839 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15840 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15843req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15844 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15845 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15846 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15847 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15848 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15849 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15850 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852req.ssl_sni : string
15853req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15854 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15855 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15856 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15857 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15858 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15859 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15860 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15861 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15862 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15863 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15864 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15865 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 ACL derivatives :
15868 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870 Examples :
15871 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15872 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15873 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15874 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15875 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015876
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015877req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15878 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15879 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15880 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15881 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15882 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15883 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15884 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15885 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15886 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888req.ssl_ver : integer
15889req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15890 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15891 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15892 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15893 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15894 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15895 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15896 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015897 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 ACL derivatives :
15901 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015902
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015903res.len : integer
15904 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15905 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15906 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15907 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15908 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15909 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15910 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15911 content inspection.
15912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15914 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015915 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15916 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15917 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15918 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15921 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15922 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15923 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15924 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015927
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015928res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15929rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15930 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15931 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15932 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15933 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15934 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15935 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15936 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938wait_end : boolean
15939 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15940 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015941 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15943 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015944 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15946 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 Examples :
15949 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15950 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15951 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15954 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15955 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15956 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15957 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15958 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15959 tcp-request content reject
15960
15961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159627.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963--------------------------------------
15964
15965It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15966This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15967data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15968its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15969HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15970content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15971to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15972more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15973response are indexed.
15974
15975base : string
15976 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15977 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15978 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15979 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15980 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15981 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15982 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15983 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15984
15985 ACL derivatives :
15986 base : exact string match
15987 base_beg : prefix match
15988 base_dir : subdir match
15989 base_dom : domain match
15990 base_end : suffix match
15991 base_len : length match
15992 base_reg : regex match
15993 base_sub : substring match
15994
15995base32 : integer
15996 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15997 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15998 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015999 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16000 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16001 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002
16003base32+src : binary
16004 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16005 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16006 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16007 per-URL counters.
16008
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016009capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16010 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16011 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16012 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16013
16014capture.req.method : string
16015 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16016 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16017 because it's allocated.
16018
16019capture.req.uri : string
16020 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16021 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16022 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16023 allocated.
16024
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016025capture.req.ver : string
16026 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16027 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16028 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16029
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016030capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16031 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16032 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16033 The first entry is an index of 0.
16034 See also: "capture response header"
16035
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016036capture.res.ver : string
16037 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16038 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16039 persistent flag.
16040
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016041req.body : binary
16042 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16043 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16044 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16045 the first chunk is analyzed.
16046
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016047req.body_param([<name>) : string
16048 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16049 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16050 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16051 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16052 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16053 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16054 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16055 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16056 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16057 given.
16058
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016059req.body_len : integer
16060 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16061 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16062 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16063 "option http-buffer-request".
16064
16065req.body_size : integer
16066 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16067 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16068 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16069 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16070 "option http-buffer-request".
16071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072req.cook([<name>]) : string
16073cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16074 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16075 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16076 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16077 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16078 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16079 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16080 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16081 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16082
16083 ACL derivatives :
16084 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16085 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16086 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16087 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16088 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16089 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16090 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16091 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16094cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16095 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16096 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016098req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16099cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16100 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16101 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16102 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16103 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16106 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16107 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16108 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16109 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016110 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16112 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16113 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16114 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16117 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16118 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16119 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16120 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016121 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16124 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16125 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16126 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16127 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16128 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16129 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16130 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16131 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16134 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16135 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16136 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16137 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16140 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16141 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16142 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16143 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16144 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16145 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16146 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16147 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016148 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016150 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016152 ACL derivatives :
16153 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16154 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16155 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16156 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16157 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16158 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16159 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16160 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16161
16162req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16163hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16164 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16165 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16166 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16167 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16168 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16169 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16170 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16171 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16172 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16173
16174req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16175hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16176 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16177 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16178 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16179 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16180 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016181 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16183 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16184
16185req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16186hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16187 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16188 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16189 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16190 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16191 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16192 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16193 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16194
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016195
16196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16198 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16199 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16200 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16201 basic auth is supported.
16202
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016203http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16204 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16205 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16206 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16207 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16209 basic auth is supported.
16210
16211 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016212 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16213 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16214 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16215 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216
16217http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016218 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16219 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16221 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223method : integer + string
16224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16225 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16226 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16227 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16228 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16229 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16230 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232 ACL derivatives :
16233 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235 Example :
16236 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16237 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16238 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240path : string
16241 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16242 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16243 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16244 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16245 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 ACL derivatives :
16250 path : exact string match
16251 path_beg : prefix match
16252 path_dir : subdir match
16253 path_dom : domain match
16254 path_end : suffix match
16255 path_len : length match
16256 path_reg : regex match
16257 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016258
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016259query : string
16260 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16261 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16262 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16263 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016264 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016265 which stops before the question mark.
16266
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016267req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16268 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16269 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16270 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16271 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273req.ver : string
16274req_ver : string (deprecated)
16275 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16276 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16277 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279 ACL derivatives :
16280 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282res.comp : boolean
16283 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16284 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16285 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287res.comp_algo : string
16288 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16289 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16290 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016292res.cook([<name>]) : string
16293scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16294 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16295 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16296 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298 ACL derivatives :
16299 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016301res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16302scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16303 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16304 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16305 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16308scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16309 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16310 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16311 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16314 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16315 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16316 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16317 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16318 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16319 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16320 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16321 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16322 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16325 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16326 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16327 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16328 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16329 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16332shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16333 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16334 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16335 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16336 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16337 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16338 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16339 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16340 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 ACL derivatives :
16343 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16344 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16345 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16346 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16347 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16348 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16349 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16350 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16351
16352res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16353shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16354 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16355 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16356 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16357 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16358 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16361shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16362 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16363 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16364 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16365 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16366 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16367 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016368
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016369res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16370 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16371 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16372 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16373 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16376shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16378 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16379 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16380 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16381 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16382 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384res.ver : string
16385resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16386 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16387 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389 ACL derivatives :
16390 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016392set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16393 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16394 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016395 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16399 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401status : integer
16402 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16403 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16404 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016405
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016406unique-id : string
16407 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16408 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16409 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16410 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16411 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16412 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016414url : string
16415 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16416 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16417 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16418 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16419 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16420 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16421 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 ACL derivatives :
16424 url : exact string match
16425 url_beg : prefix match
16426 url_dir : subdir match
16427 url_dom : domain match
16428 url_end : suffix match
16429 url_len : length match
16430 url_reg : regex match
16431 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433url_ip : ip
16434 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16435 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16436 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16437 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16438 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16439 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16440 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442url_port : integer
16443 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16444 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16445 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16446 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016447
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016448urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16449url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16451 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016452 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16453 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16454 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16455 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016456 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16457 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016458 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16459 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461 ACL derivatives :
16462 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16463 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16464 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16465 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16466 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16467 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16468 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16469 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016470
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472 Example :
16473 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16474 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16475 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16476 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016477
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016478urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16480 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16481 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016482
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016483url32 : integer
16484 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16485 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16486 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16487 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16488 is an unsigned integer.
16489
16490url32+src : binary
16491 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16492 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16493 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16494
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164967.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016497---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016499Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16500every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016501order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016503ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16504---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016505FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016506HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016507HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16508HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016509HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16510HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16511HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16512HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16513LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016514METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016515METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016516METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16517METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16518METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16519METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016520METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016521METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016522RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016523REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016524TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016525WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16526---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016527
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165298. Logging
16530----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016531
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016532One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16533provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16534very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16535provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16536state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016537to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016538headers.
16539
16540In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16541about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16542send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16543
16544 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16545 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16546 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16547 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16548 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016550 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016551
16552The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16553allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16554as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16555while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16556real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16557delay.
16558
16559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165608.1. Log levels
16561---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016562
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016563TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016564source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016565HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16566in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16567track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16568syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16569about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016570
16571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165728.2. Log formats
16573----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016574
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016575HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016576and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16577slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16578options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016579
16580 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16581 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16582 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16583 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16584 extents.
16585
16586 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16587 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16588 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16589 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16590 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16591
16592 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16593 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16594 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16595 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16596 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16597
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016598 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16599 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16600 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16601 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16602
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016603 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16604
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016605Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16606specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16607field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16608servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16609always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16610identifier.
16611
16612Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16613 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16614 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16615 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16616 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16617
16618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166198.2.1. Default log format
16620-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016621
16622This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16623as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16624format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16625
16626 Example :
16627 listen www
16628 mode http
16629 log global
16630 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16631
16632 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16633 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16634 (www/HTTP)
16635
16636 Field Format Extract from the example above
16637 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16638 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16639 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16640 4 'to' to
16641 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16642 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16643
16644Detailed fields description :
16645 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16646 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16647 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16648 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16649 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16650 and processed the connection.
16651 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16652
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016653In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16654"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16655connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16656
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016657It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16658will eventually disappear.
16659
16660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166618.2.2. TCP log format
16662---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663
16664The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16665is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16666information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16667counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16668emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16669environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16670the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16671sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016672specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16673not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16674fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16675marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016676
16677 Example :
16678 frontend fnt
16679 mode tcp
16680 option tcplog
16681 log global
16682 default_backend bck
16683
16684 backend bck
16685 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16686
16687 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16688 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16689 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16690
16691 Field Format Extract from the example above
16692 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16693 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16694 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16695 4 frontend_name fnt
16696 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16697 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16698 7 bytes_read* 212
16699 8 termination_state --
16700 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16701 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16702
16703Detailed fields description :
16704 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016705 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16706 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16707 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016708 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016709 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016710 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016711
16712 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016713 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16714 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16715 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16718 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16719 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016720 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16721 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16722 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16723 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016724
16725 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16726 and processed the connection.
16727
16728 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16729 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16730 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16731 applications.
16732
16733 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16734 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16735 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16736 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16737 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16738
16739 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16740 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16741 See "Timers" below for more details.
16742
16743 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16744 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16745 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16746 "Timers" below for more details.
16747
16748 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016749 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016750 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16751 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16752 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16753 details.
16754
16755 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16756 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16757 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16758 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16759 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16760
16761 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16762 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16763 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16764 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16765 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16766 for more details.
16767
16768 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016769 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016770 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16771 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16772 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016773 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774
16775 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16776 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16777 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16778 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16779 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16780 caused by a denial of service attack.
16781
16782 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16783 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16784 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16785 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16786 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16787 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16788 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16789 denial of service attack.
16790
16791 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16792 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16793 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16794 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16795 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16796 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16797 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16798 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16799 be processed than on other servers.
16800
16801 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16802 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16803 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16804 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16805 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16806 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16807 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16808 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16809 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16810 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16811 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16812 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16813 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16814
16815 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16816 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16817 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16818 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16819 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16820 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016821 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016822 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16823
16824 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16825 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16826 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16827 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16828 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16829 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016831 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16832 occurs.
16833
16834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168358.2.3. HTTP log format
16836----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016837
16838The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16839is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16840the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16841are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16842emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16843generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16844"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16845which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016846frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16847is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016848
16849Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16850slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16851with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16852
16853 Example :
16854 frontend http-in
16855 mode http
16856 option httplog
16857 log global
16858 default_backend bck
16859
16860 backend static
16861 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16862
16863 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16864 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16865 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016866 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867
16868 Field Format Extract from the example above
16869 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16870 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016871 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016872 4 frontend_name http-in
16873 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016874 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016875 7 status_code 200
16876 8 bytes_read* 2750
16877 9 captured_request_cookie -
16878 10 captured_response_cookie -
16879 11 termination_state ----
16880 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16881 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16882 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16883 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16884 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016885
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016886Detailed fields description :
16887 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016888 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16889 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16890 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016891 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016892 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016893 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016894
16895 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016896 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16897 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16898 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016900 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16901 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016902
16903 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16904 and processed the connection.
16905
16906 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16907 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16908 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16909
16910 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16911 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16912 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16913 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16914 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16915 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016917 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16918 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16919 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16920 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16921 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16922 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016923 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16924 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
16926 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16927 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016928 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016929
16930 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16931 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016932 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16933 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016934
16935 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16936 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16937 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16938 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16939 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016940 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16941 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016942
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016943 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16944 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16945 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16946 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16947 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16948 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16949 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016950 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016951
16952 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16953 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16954 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16955
16956 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16957 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16958 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16959 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16960 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16961 overflowing.
16962
16963 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16964 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16965 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16966 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16967 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16968 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16969 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16970 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16971
16972 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16973 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16974 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16975 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16976 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16977 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16978 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16979 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16980
16981 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16982 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16983 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16984 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16985 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16986 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16987 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16988
16989 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016990 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016991 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16992 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16993 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016994 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995 system.
16996
16997 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16998 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16999 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17000 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17001 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17002 caused by a denial of service attack.
17003
17004 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17005 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17006 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17007 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17008 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17009 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17010 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17011 denial of service attack.
17012
17013 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17014 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17015 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17016 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17017 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17018 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17019 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17020 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17021 processed than on other servers.
17022
17023 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17024 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17025 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17026 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17027 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17028 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17029 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17030 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17031 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17032 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17033 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17034 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17035 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17036
17037 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17038 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17039 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17040 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17041 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17042 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017043 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17045
17046 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17047 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17048 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17049 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17050 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17051 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017052 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017053 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17054 occurs.
17055
17056 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17057 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17058 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17059 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17060 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17061 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17062 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17063 cookies" below for more details.
17064
17065 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17066 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17067 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17068 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17069 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17070 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17071 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17072 and cookies" below for more details.
17073
17074 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17075 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17076 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17077 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17078 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17079 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17080 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17081 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17082
17083
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200170848.2.4. Custom log format
17085------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017086
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017087The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017088mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017089
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017090HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017091Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17092separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17093prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17094
17095Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17096variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017097("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017098
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017099If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017100as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017101less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17102the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17103
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017104Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017105In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017106in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017107
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017108Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17109'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17110https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17111such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17112
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017113Flags are :
17114 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017115 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017116 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17117 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017118
17119 Example:
17120
17121 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17122 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17123
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017124 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17125
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017126At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17127
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017128 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17129 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017130
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017131the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017132
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017133 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17134 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17135 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017136
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017137and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017139 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17140 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017141
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017142Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17143
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017144 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017145 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017146 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17147 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17148 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017149 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17150 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17151 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017152 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017153 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17154 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017155 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017156 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17157 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017158 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017159 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017160 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017161 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017162 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017163 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017164 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017165 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17166 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17167 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17168 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17169 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017170 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017171 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17172 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017173 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017174 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17175 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017176 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17177 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17178 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017179 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017180 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17181 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017182 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017183 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17184 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17185 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017186 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017187 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017188 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17189 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17190 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17191 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017192 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017193 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017194 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017195 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017196 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017197 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017198 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17199 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17200 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017201 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017202 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17203 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017204 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017205 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17206 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017207 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017208 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017209 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017210 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017211
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017212 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017213
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017214
172158.2.5. Error log format
17216-----------------------
17217
17218When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17219protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17220By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17221"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017222will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017223logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17224
17225The format looks like this :
17226
17227 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17228 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17229 Connection error during SSL handshake
17230
17231 Field Format Extract from the example above
17232 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17233 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17234 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17235 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17236 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17237
17238These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17239failures.
17240
17241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172428.3. Advanced logging options
17243-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17246just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17247options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17248for more information about their usage.
17249
17250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17252------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017253
17254It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17255haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17256commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17257monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17258ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17259
17260 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17261 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17262 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17263 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17264
17265 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17266 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17267 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017268 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269 such as other load-balancers.
17270
17271 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17272 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17273 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17274
17275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172768.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17277----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017278
17279The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17280what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17281or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017282"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017283just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17284log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17285after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17286is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17287with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17288with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17289
17290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17292------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017293
17294Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17295for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17296"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17297retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17298raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17299a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17300file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17301you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17302"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17303
17304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17306--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017307
17308Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17309multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17310them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17311"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17312logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17313error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17314and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17315too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17316useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17317alternative.
17318
17319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173208.4. Timing events
17321------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017322
17323Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17324reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17325the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17326frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017327mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17328addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17329
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017330Timings events in HTTP mode:
17331
17332 first request 2nd request
17333 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17334 t tr t tr ...
17335 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17336 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17337 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17338 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17339 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17340
17341Timings events in TCP mode:
17342
17343 TCP session
17344 |<----------------->|
17345 t t
17346 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17347 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17348 |<------ Tt ------->|
17349
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017350 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017351 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017352 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17353 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17354 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017355 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017356 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17357 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17358 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17359 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017360
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017361 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17362 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17363 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017364 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17365 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17366 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17367 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17368 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17369 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017370
17371 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17372 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17373 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17374 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17375 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17376 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17377 request typed by hand during a test.
17378
17379 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17380 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017381 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017382 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17383 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17384 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17385 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017386
17387 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17388 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17389 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17390 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17391 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17392
17393 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17394 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17395 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17396 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17397 connection never established.
17398
17399 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17400 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17401 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17402 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17403 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17404 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17405 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17406 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17407 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17408 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17409 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17410
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017411 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17412 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17413 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17414 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17415 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17416 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17417
17418 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17419
17420 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17421 "Ta" can never be negative.
17422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17424 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017425 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17426 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017427 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017428
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017429 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017430
17431 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017432 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17433 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434
17435These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17436protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17437that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017438due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17439"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17440that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017441
17442Most common cases :
17443
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017444 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17445 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17446 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17447 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17448 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17449 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17450 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17451 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17452 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17453 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17454 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017455 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017456
17457 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17458 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17459 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17460 of ms on remote networks.
17461
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017462 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17463 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17464 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017466 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17467 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17468 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17469 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17470 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17471 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17472 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17473 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17474 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017475
17476Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17477
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017478 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017479 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017480 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017481
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017482 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017483 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17484 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17485
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017486 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17488 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17489 flags.
17490
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017491 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17492 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017493 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17494 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17495 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17496 the client connection was maintained open.
17497
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017498 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017499 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017500 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017501 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17502
17503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175048.5. Session state at disconnection
17505-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017506
17507TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17508"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175092-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17510each of which has a special meaning :
17511
17512 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17513 session to terminate :
17514
17515 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17516
17517 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17518 server explicitly refused it.
17519
17520 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17521 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17522 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17523 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017524 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017525
17526 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17527 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017528
17529 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17530 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17531 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17532 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17533 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17534
17535 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17536 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17537 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17538 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17539 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17540
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017541 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17542 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17543
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017544 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17545 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17546 backup connections when going up.
17547
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017548 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17549
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017550 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17551 send or receive data.
17552
17553 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17554 send or receive data.
17555
17556 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17557 with nothing left in the buffers.
17558
17559 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17560
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017561 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17563
17564 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17565 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17566 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17567 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17568 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17569
17570 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17571 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17572
17573 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17574 server (HTTP only).
17575
17576 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17577
17578 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17579 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17580 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17581
17582 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17583 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17584 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17585
17586 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17587
17588 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17589 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17590
17591 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17592 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17593 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17594
17595 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17596 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017597 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17598 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017599
17600 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17601 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17602 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17603 another server.
17604
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017605 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017606 server.
17607
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017608 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17609 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17610 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17611 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17612
17613 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17614 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17615 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17616 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17617
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017618 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17619 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17620 "use-server" rule).
17621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017622 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17623
17624 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17625 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17626
17627 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17628
17629 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17630 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17631 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17632
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017633 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17634 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017635 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017636 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17637 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17638
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017639 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17640
17641 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17642 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17643
17644 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17645
17646 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17647
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017648The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17649was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017650helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17651starvation, attacks, etc...
17652
17653The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17654alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17655easier finding and understanding.
17656
17657 Flags Reason
17658
17659 -- Normal termination.
17660
17661 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17662 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17663 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17664 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17665
17666 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17667 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17668 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17669 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17670 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17671 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017672
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17674 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017675 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017676
17677 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17678 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17679 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17680
17681 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17682 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17683 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17684 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17685 the server takes too long to respond.
17686
17687 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17688 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17689 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17690 long a time to respond.
17691
17692 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17693 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17694 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17695 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017696 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17697 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017698
17699 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17700 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17701 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17702 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17703 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017704 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017705 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17706 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17707 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17708 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17709 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17710 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17711 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17712 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017713 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017714 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17715 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17716 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17719 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017720 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17721 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17722 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17723 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017724
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017725 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17726 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017728 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017729 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17730 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017731 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017732 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17733 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17734
17735 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17736 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17737 503 or 504 here.
17738
17739 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17740 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17741 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17742 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17743 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17744
17745 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17746 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017747 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017748 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17749 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17750
17751 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17752 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17753 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17754 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17755 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17756 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17757 between haproxy and the server.
17758
17759 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17760 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17761 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17762 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17763 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17764 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17765 solution is to fix the application.
17766
17767 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17768 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17769 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17770 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17771 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17772 external attacks.
17773
17774 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17775 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017776 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017777 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17778 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17779
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017780 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17781 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17782 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017783 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017784 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017785
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17787 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17788 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17789 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017790 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17791 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17792 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17793 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17794 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017795
17796 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17797 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17798 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17799 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17800
17801 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17802 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17803 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17804 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17805
17806 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17807 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17808 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17809 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17810
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017811The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17812persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17813important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17814re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17815
17816 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17817
17818 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17819 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17820 set on a GET request.
17821
17822 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17823 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017824 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017825 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17826
17827 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17828 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17829 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17830
17831 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17832 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17833 already got a cookie.
17834
17835 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17836 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17837 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17838 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17839 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17840
17841 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17842 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17843 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17844
17845 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17846 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17847 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17848
17849 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17850 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17851
17852 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17853 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17854 then advertised in the response.
17855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178578.6. Non-printable characters
17858-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017859
17860In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17861consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17862converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17863prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17864being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17865escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17866is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17867'}' when logging headers.
17868
17869Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17870issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17871containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17872
17873Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17874the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17875performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17876
17877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178788.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17879---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017880
17881Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17882achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017883section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017884cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17885the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17886the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017887locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017888not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17889user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17890a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17891wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17892
17893 Examples :
17894 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17895 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17896
17897 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17898 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17899
17900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179018.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17902---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017903
17904Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17905proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17906the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17907server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17908
17909Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17910response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017911section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017912
17913It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017914time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17915appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017916are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17917and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17918follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17919request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17920in the logs.
17921
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017922As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17923frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17924an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17925
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 Example :
17927 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17928 listen proxy-out
17929 mode http
17930 option httplog
17931 option logasap
17932 log global
17933 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17934
17935 # log the name of the virtual server
17936 capture request header Host len 20
17937
17938 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17939 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17940
17941 # log the beginning of the referrer
17942 capture request header Referer len 20
17943
17944 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17945 capture response header Server len 20
17946
17947 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17948 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17949
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017950 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017951 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17952
17953 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17954 capture response header Via len 20
17955
17956 # log the URL location during a redirection
17957 capture response header Location len 20
17958
17959 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17960 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17961 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17962 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17963 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17964
17965 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17966 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17967 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17968 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017969 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017970
17971 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17972 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17973 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17974 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17975 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017976 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017977
17978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179798.9. Examples of logs
17980---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017981
17982These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17983them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17984reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17985
17986 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17987 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17988 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17989
17990 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17991 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17992
17993 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17994 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17995 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17996
17997 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17998 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17999
18000 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18001 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18002 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18003
18004 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018005 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018006 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18007 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18008
18009 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18010 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18011 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18012
18013 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18014 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018015 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18017 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18018 to return the 502 and not the server.
18019
18020 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018021 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018022
18023 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18024 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18025 Nothing was sent to any server.
18026
18027 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18028 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18029
18030 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18031 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018032 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018033 send a 408 return code to the client.
18034
18035 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18036 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18037
18038 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18039 5 seconds ("c----").
18040
18041 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18042 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018043 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018044
18045 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018046 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018047 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18048 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18049 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18050 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18051 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018052
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018053
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200180549. Supported filters
18055--------------------
18056
18057Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18058accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18059unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18060
18061See also : "filter"
18062
180639.1. Trace
18064----------
18065
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018066filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018067
18068 Arguments:
18069 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18070 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18071
18072 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18073 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18074 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18075 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18076
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018077 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018078 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18079 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18080 amount of the parsed data.
18081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018082 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018083
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018084This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18085callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18086information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18087filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18088
18089Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18090tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18091a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18092
18093
180949.2. HTTP compression
18095---------------------
18096
18097filter compression
18098
18099The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18100keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018101when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18102it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18103response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18104line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18105cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18106the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018107
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018108See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018109
18110
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18112--------------------------------------------
18113
18114filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18115
18116 Arguments :
18117
18118 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18119 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18120 parsed.
18121
18122 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18123 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18124 part must be placed in its own scope.
18125
18126The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18127external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018128streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018129exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18130also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18131
18132SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18133the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18134
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018135For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018136"doc/SPOE.txt".
18137
18138Important note:
18139 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18140 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18141
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181429.4. Cache
18143----------
18144
18145filter cache <name>
18146
18147 Arguments :
18148
18149 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18150
18151The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18152"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18153cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018154other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18155the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18156mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18157filter other than the compression is used for the same
18158listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18159order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018160
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018161See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018162
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001816310. Cache
18164---------
18165
18166HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18167(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18168RAM.
18169
18170The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018171this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018172
18173If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18174independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18175when we try to allocate a new one.
18176
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018177The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018178
18179It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18180"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18181for more details.
18182
18183When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18184replaced by "<CACHE>".
18185
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001818610.1. Limitation
18187----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018188
18189The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18190
18191- If the response is not a 200
18192- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018193- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018194- If the response is not cacheable
18195
18196- If the request is not a GET
18197- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018198- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018199
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018200Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18201filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18202can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18203example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18204"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018205
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001820610.2. Setup
18207-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018208
18209To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18210the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18211
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001821210.2.1. Cache section
18213---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018214
18215cache <name>
18216 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18217 size of cache is mandatory.
18218
18219total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018220 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018221 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018222
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018223max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018224 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18225 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18226 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018227
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018228max-age <seconds>
18229 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18230 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18231 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18232 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18233 default.
18234
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001823510.2.2. Proxy section
18236---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018237
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018238http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018239 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18240 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18241 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18242 after this one.
18243
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018244http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018245 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18246 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18247 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18248 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18249
18250
18251Example:
18252
18253 backend bck1
18254 mode http
18255
18256 http-request cache-use foobar
18257 http-response cache-store foobar
18258 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18259
18260 cache foobar
18261 total-max-size 4
18262 max-age 240
18263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018264/*
18265 * Local variables:
18266 * fill-column: 79
18267 * End:
18268 */